From 6b896a9e1dc143bba86795be1e9336549db9b85f Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: SomeDude Date: Thu, 24 Jan 2008 18:26:00 +0100 Subject: [PATCH] version 0.1.0 --- CMakeLists.txt | 52 +- admin/createidentity.php | 2 +- admin/identitytrust.php | 39 +- admin/introduce.php | 18 +- include/base64.h | 2 +- include/board.h | 38 + include/boardlist.h | 31 + include/freenet/identityrequester.h | 2 +- include/freenet/iindexinserter.h | 159 + include/freenet/iindexrequester.h | 193 + include/freenet/messageinserter.h | 22 + include/freenet/messagelistinserter.h | 23 + include/freenet/messagelistrequester.h | 21 + include/freenet/messagelistxml.h | 40 + include/freenet/messagerequester.h | 26 + include/freenet/messagexml.h | 49 + include/global.h | 24 + include/hex.h | 2 +- include/identitytestglobal.h | 24 - include/ifmsxmldocument.h | 9 + include/message.h | 64 + include/messagelist.h | 21 + include/nntp/mime/Mime.h | 496 + include/nntp/mime/MimeChar.h | 34 + include/nntp/mime/MimeCode.h | 335 + include/nntp/nntpconnection.h | 83 + include/nntp/nntplistener.h | 32 + include/nntp/uwildmat.h | 17 + include/stringfunctions.h | 6 + include/xyssl/sha1.h | 2 +- libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.c | 113931 ++++++++++++++++++++++++ libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.h | 3840 + libs/sqlite3/sqlite3ext.h | 350 + libs/tinyxml/tinystr.cpp | 116 + libs/tinyxml/tinystr.h | 319 + libs/tinyxml/tinyxml.cpp | 1888 + libs/tinyxml/tinyxml.h | 1802 + libs/tinyxml/tinyxmlerror.cpp | 53 + libs/tinyxml/tinyxmlparser.cpp | 1638 + src/board.cpp | 127 + src/boardlist.cpp | 38 + src/freenet/captcha/simplecaptcha.cpp | 2 +- src/freenet/freenetmasterthread.cpp | 8 + src/freenet/identityintroductioninserter.cpp | 2 +- src/freenet/identityintroductionxml.cpp | 2 +- src/freenet/introductionpuzzlexml.cpp | 2 +- src/freenet/messageinserter.cpp | 129 + src/freenet/messagelistinserter.cpp | 182 + src/freenet/messagelistrequester.cpp | 227 + src/freenet/messagelistxml.cpp | 145 + src/freenet/messagerequester.cpp | 299 + src/freenet/messagexml.cpp | 153 + src/freenet/trustlistinserter.cpp | 2 +- src/global.cpp | 479 + src/identitytestglobal.cpp | 370 - src/main.cpp | 5 +- src/message.cpp | 404 + src/messagelist.cpp | 34 + src/nntp/mime/Mime.cpp | 967 + src/nntp/mime/MimeChar.cpp | 142 + src/nntp/mime/MimeCode.cpp | 946 + src/nntp/mime/MimeType.cpp | 45 + src/nntp/nntpconnection.cpp | 1186 + src/nntp/nntplistener.cpp | 175 + src/nntp/uwildmat.cpp | 403 + src/option.cpp | 2 +- src/socketdefines.cpp | 1 + src/uuidgenerator.cpp | 2 +- src/xyssl/sha1.c | 2 +- 69 files changed, 131856 insertions(+), 428 deletions(-) create mode 100644 include/board.h create mode 100644 include/boardlist.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/iindexinserter.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/iindexrequester.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/messageinserter.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/messagelistinserter.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/messagelistrequester.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/messagelistxml.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/messagerequester.h create mode 100644 include/freenet/messagexml.h create mode 100644 include/global.h delete mode 100644 include/identitytestglobal.h create mode 100644 include/message.h create mode 100644 include/messagelist.h create mode 100644 include/nntp/mime/Mime.h create mode 100644 include/nntp/mime/MimeChar.h create mode 100644 include/nntp/mime/MimeCode.h create mode 100644 include/nntp/nntpconnection.h create mode 100644 include/nntp/nntplistener.h create mode 100644 include/nntp/uwildmat.h create mode 100644 libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.c create mode 100644 libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.h create mode 100644 libs/sqlite3/sqlite3ext.h create mode 100644 libs/tinyxml/tinystr.cpp create mode 100644 libs/tinyxml/tinystr.h create mode 100644 libs/tinyxml/tinyxml.cpp create mode 100644 libs/tinyxml/tinyxml.h create mode 100644 libs/tinyxml/tinyxmlerror.cpp create mode 100644 libs/tinyxml/tinyxmlparser.cpp create mode 100644 src/board.cpp create mode 100644 src/boardlist.cpp create mode 100644 src/freenet/messageinserter.cpp create mode 100644 src/freenet/messagelistinserter.cpp create mode 100644 src/freenet/messagelistrequester.cpp create mode 100644 src/freenet/messagelistxml.cpp create mode 100644 src/freenet/messagerequester.cpp create mode 100644 src/freenet/messagexml.cpp create mode 100644 src/global.cpp delete mode 100644 src/identitytestglobal.cpp create mode 100644 src/message.cpp create mode 100644 src/messagelist.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/mime/Mime.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/mime/MimeChar.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/mime/MimeCode.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/mime/MimeType.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/nntpconnection.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/nntplistener.cpp create mode 100644 src/nntp/uwildmat.cpp diff --git a/CMakeLists.txt b/CMakeLists.txt index 8cace60..5217bdc 100644 --- a/CMakeLists.txt +++ b/CMakeLists.txt @@ -2,12 +2,16 @@ PROJECT(fms) SET(FMS_SRC src/base64.cpp +src/board.cpp +src/boardlist.cpp src/commandthread.cpp src/datetime.cpp +src/global.cpp src/hex.cpp -src/identitytestglobal.cpp src/logfile.cpp src/main.cpp +src/message.cpp +src/messagelist.cpp src/option.cpp src/socketdefines.cpp src/stringfunctions.cpp @@ -28,6 +32,12 @@ src/freenet/introductionpuzzleinserter.cpp src/freenet/introductionpuzzleremover.cpp src/freenet/introductionpuzzlerequester.cpp src/freenet/introductionpuzzlexml.cpp +src/freenet/messageinserter.cpp +src/freenet/messagelistinserter.cpp +src/freenet/messagelistrequester.cpp +src/freenet/messagelistxml.cpp +src/freenet/messagerequester.cpp +src/freenet/messagexml.cpp src/freenet/trustlistinserter.cpp src/freenet/trustlistrequester.cpp src/freenet/trustlistxml.cpp @@ -36,27 +46,49 @@ src/freenet/captcha/simplecaptcha.cpp src/freenet/captcha/easybmp/EasyBMP.cpp src/freenet/captcha/easybmp/EasyBMP_Font.cpp src/freenet/captcha/easybmp/EasyBMP_Geometry.cpp +src/nntp/nntpconnection.cpp +src/nntp/nntplistener.cpp +src/nntp/uwildmat.cpp +src/nntp/mime/Mime.cpp +src/nntp/mime/MimeChar.cpp +src/nntp/mime/MimeCode.cpp +src/nntp/mime/MimeType.cpp src/xyssl/sha1.c ) ADD_DEFINITIONS(-DTIXML_USE_STL) +ADD_LIBRARY(sqlite3 libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.c) +ADD_LIBRARY(tinyxml libs/tinyxml/tinystr.cpp libs/tinyxml/tinyxml.cpp libs/tinyxml/tinyxmlerror.cpp libs/tinyxml/tinyxmlparser.cpp) + ADD_EXECUTABLE(fms ${FMS_SRC}) -FIND_LIBRARY(SQLITE3_LIBRARY NAMES sqlite3 sqlite3_s) -FIND_LIBRARY(TINYXML_LIBRARY NAMES tinyxml tinyxml_s) -FIND_LIBRARY(ZTHREADS_LIBRARY NAMES zthread zthread_s) +INCLUDE_DIRECTORIES(libs/sqlite3 libs/tinyxml) + +TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms sqlite3 tinyxml) IF(WIN32) TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms ws2_32) ENDIF(WIN32) -IF(SQLITE3_LIBRARY) - TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms ${SQLITE3_LIBRARY}) -ENDIF(SQLITE3_LIBRARY) -IF(TINYXML_LIBRARY) - TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms ${TINYXML_LIBRARY}) -ENDIF(TINYXML_LIBRARY) +#FIND_LIBRARY(SQLITE3_LIBRARY NAMES sqlite3 sqlite3_s) +#FIND_LIBRARY(TINYXML_LIBRARY NAMES tinyxml tinyxml_s) +FIND_LIBRARY(ZTHREADS_LIBRARY NAMES zthread ZThread zthread_s) + +#IF(SQLITE3_LIBRARY) +# TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms ${SQLITE3_LIBRARY}) +#ELSE(SQLITE3_LIBRARY) +# MESSAGE(FATAL_ERROR "Could not find SQLite library. You must set the location manually.") +#ENDIF(SQLITE3_LIBRARY) + +#IF(TINYXML_LIBRARY) +# TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms ${TINYXML_LIBRARY}) +#ELSE(TINYXML_LIBRARY) +# MESSAGE(FATAL_ERROR "Could not find TinyXML library. You must set the location manually.") +#ENDIF(TINYXML_LIBRARY) + IF(ZTHREADS_LIBRARY) TARGET_LINK_LIBRARIES(fms ${ZTHREADS_LIBRARY}) +ELSE(ZTHREADS_LIBRARY) + MESSAGE(FATAL_ERROR "Could not find ZThreads library. You must set the location manually.") ENDIF(ZTHREADS_LIBRARY) diff --git a/admin/createidentity.php b/admin/createidentity.php index b3b76f7..804b4cf 100644 --- a/admin/createidentity.php +++ b/admin/createidentity.php @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ function content() if(isset($_REQUEST["formaction"]) && $_REQUEST["formaction"]=="create" && $_REQUEST["name"]!="") { $db=new PDO('sqlite:'.$dblocation); - $st=$db->prepare("INSERT INTO tblLocalIdentity(Name) VALUES(?);"); + $st=$db->prepare("INSERT INTO tblLocalIdentity(Name,PublishTrustList) VALUES(?,'true');"); $st->bindParam(1,$_REQUEST["name"]); $st->execute(); ?> diff --git a/admin/identitytrust.php b/admin/identitytrust.php index 51803f0..8e5aa1e 100644 --- a/admin/identitytrust.php +++ b/admin/identitytrust.php @@ -9,10 +9,28 @@ function content() global $dblocation; $db=new PDO('sqlite:'.$dblocation); + + if(isset($_REQUEST['formaction']) && $_REQUEST['formaction']=='updatetrust') + { + $st=$db->prepare("UPDATE tblIdentity SET LocalMessageTrust=?, LocalTrustListTrust=? WHERE IdentityID=?;"); + for($i=0; $ibindParam(1,$_REQUEST['newlocalmessagetrust'][$i]); + $st->bindParam(2,$_REQUEST['newlocaltrustlisttrust'][$i]); + $st->bindParam(3,$_REQUEST['identityid'][$i]); + $rval=$st->execute(); + } + } + } + $st=$db->prepare("SELECT IdentityID,Name,LocalMessageTrust,PeerMessageTrust,LocalTrustListTrust,PeerTrustListTrust FROM tblIdentity ORDER BY Name;"); $st->execute(); ?>

Identity Trust

+
+ @@ -26,16 +44,31 @@ function content() { ?> - - + + - + + + +
Peer
+ + + + + + + + +
+ +
+
Type answers for a few puzzles and submit
"; - $st=$db->prepare("SELECT UUID,Day FROM tblIntroductionPuzzleRequests WHERE UUID NOT IN (SELECT UUID FROM tblIdentityIntroductionInserts) AND Day>='".gmdate('Y-m-d',strtotime('-1 day'))."' AND Found='true';"); + $st=$db->prepare("SELECT UUID,Day,IdentityID FROM tblIntroductionPuzzleRequests WHERE UUID NOT IN (SELECT UUID FROM tblIdentityIntroductionInserts) AND Day>='".gmdate('Y-m-d',strtotime('-1 day'))."' AND Found='true' ORDER BY IdentityID, RequestIndex DESC;"); $st->execute(); + // only show latest captcha for each known identity + $lastid=''; while($record=$st->fetch()) { - print ""; - print ""; - print ""; - print ""; - print "
"; + if($lastid!=$record[2]) + { + $lastid=$record[2]; + print ""; + print ""; + print ""; + print ""; + print "
"; + } } ?> diff --git a/include/base64.h b/include/base64.h index 276f7da..f853e0b 100644 --- a/include/base64.h +++ b/include/base64.h @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ const bool Decode(const std::string &encoded, std::vector &data); } // namespace -#endif _base64_ +#endif // _base64_ diff --git a/include/board.h b/include/board.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..2230f00 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/board.h @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +#ifndef _board_ +#define _board_ + +#include "datetime.h" +#include "ilogger.h" +#include "idatabase.h" + +#include + +class Board:public ILogger,public IDatabase +{ +public: + Board(); + Board(const long boardid); + Board(const std::string &boardname); + + const bool Load(const long boardid); + const bool Load(const std::string &boardname); + + const long GetBoardID() const { return m_boardid; } + std::string GetBoardName() const { return m_boardname; } + std::string GetBoardDescription() const { return m_boarddescription; } + DateTime GetDateCreated() const { return m_datecreated; } + const long GetLowMessageID() const { return m_lowmessageid; } + const long GetHighMessageID() const { return m_highmessageid; } + const long GetMessageCount() const { return m_messagecount; } + +private: + long m_boardid; + std::string m_boardname; + std::string m_boarddescription; + DateTime m_datecreated; + long m_lowmessageid; // lowest id of all message currently in this board + long m_highmessageid; // highest id of all message currently in this board + long m_messagecount; // number of messages in this board +}; + +#endif _board_ diff --git a/include/boardlist.h b/include/boardlist.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a5c9508 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/boardlist.h @@ -0,0 +1,31 @@ +#ifndef _boardlist_ +#define _boardlist_ + +#include "board.h" +#include "ilogger.h" +#include "idatabase.h" + +#include + +/** + \brief +*/ +class BoardList:public std::vector,public ILogger,public IDatabase +{ +public: + + /** + \brief Loads all known boards + */ + void Load(); + + /** + \brief Loads boards added after specified date + */ + void LoadNew(const std::string &date); + +private: + +}; + +#endif // _boardlist_ diff --git a/include/freenet/identityrequester.h b/include/freenet/identityrequester.h index ebea425..2ded93a 100644 --- a/include/freenet/identityrequester.h +++ b/include/freenet/identityrequester.h @@ -33,8 +33,8 @@ private: void RemoveFromRequestList(const long identityid); DateTime m_tempdate; - std::string m_messagebase; long m_maxrequests; + std::string m_messagebase; std::vector m_requesting; // list of ids we are currently requesting from std::map m_ids; // map of all ids we know and whether we have requested file from them yet diff --git a/include/freenet/iindexinserter.h b/include/freenet/iindexinserter.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d7093a3 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/iindexinserter.h @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +#ifndef _iindexinserter_ +#define _iindexinserter_ + +#include "../idatabase.h" +#include "../ilogger.h" +#include "../option.h" +#include "../datetime.h" +#include "../stringfunctions.h" +#include "ifreenetregistrable.h" +#include "ifcpconnected.h" +#include "ifcpmessagehandler.h" +#include "iperiodicprocessor.h" + +template +class IIndexInserter:public IFreenetRegistrable,public IFCPConnected,public IFCPMessageHandler,public IPeriodicProcessor,public IDatabase,public ILogger +{ +public: + IIndexInserter(); + IIndexInserter(FCPv2 *fcp); + + virtual void FCPConnected(); + virtual void FCPDisconnected(); + virtual const bool HandleMessage(FCPMessage &message); + + virtual void Process(); + + virtual void RegisterWithThread(FreenetMasterThread *thread); + +protected: + void InitializeIIndexInserter(); + virtual void Initialize()=0; // initialize m_fcpuniquename + virtual const bool HandlePutSuccessful(FCPMessage &message)=0; + virtual const bool HandlePutFailed(FCPMessage &message)=0; + virtual void StartInsert(const IDTYPE &id)=0; + virtual void CheckForNeededInsert()=0; + virtual void RemoveFromInsertList(const IDTYPE id); + + std::vector m_inserting; // list of ids we are inserting + std::string m_messagebase; + DateTime m_lastchecked; + + // these MUST be populated by child class + std::string m_fcpuniquename; +}; + +template +IIndexInserter::IIndexInserter() +{ + InitializeIIndexInserter(); +} + +template +IIndexInserter::IIndexInserter(FCPv2 *fcp):IFCPConnected(fcp) +{ + InitializeIIndexInserter(); +} + +template +void IIndexInserter::FCPConnected() +{ + // make sure variables have been initialized by the derived class + if(m_fcpuniquename=="") + { + m_log->WriteLog(LogFile::LOGLEVEL_ERROR,"IIndexInserter::FCPConnected fcpuniquename not initialized correctly!"); + } + if(m_fcpuniquename.find("|")!=std::string::npos) + { + m_log->WriteLog(LogFile::LOGLEVEL_ERROR,"IIndexInserter::FCPConnected fcpuniquename contains | character! This is not a valid character!"); + } + + m_inserting.clear(); +} + +template +void IIndexInserter::FCPDisconnected() +{ + +} + +template +const bool IIndexInserter::HandleMessage(FCPMessage &message) +{ + + if(message["Identifier"].find(m_fcpuniquename)==0) + { + if(message.GetName()=="URIGenerated") + { + return true; + } + + if(message.GetName()=="PutSuccessful") + { + return HandlePutSuccessful(message); + } + + if(message.GetName()=="PutFailed") + { + return HandlePutFailed(message); + } + + if(message.GetName()=="IdentifierCollision") + { + // remove one of the ids from the requesting list + IDTYPE id; + std::vector idparts; + StringFunctions::Split(message["Identifier"],"|",idparts); + StringFunctions::Convert(idparts[1],id); + RemoveFromInsertList(id); + return true; + } + } + + return false; +} + +template +void IIndexInserter::InitializeIIndexInserter() +{ + m_fcpuniquename=""; + Option::instance()->Get("MessageBase",m_messagebase); + m_lastchecked.SetToGMTime(); +} + +template +void IIndexInserter::Process() +{ + DateTime now; + now.SetToGMTime(); + + if(m_lastchecked<(now-(1.0/1440.0))) + { + CheckForNeededInsert(); + m_lastchecked=now; + } +} + +template +void IIndexInserter::RegisterWithThread(FreenetMasterThread *thread) +{ + thread->RegisterFCPConnected(this); + thread->RegisterFCPMessageHandler(this); + thread->RegisterPeriodicProcessor(this); +} + +template +void IIndexInserter::RemoveFromInsertList(const IDTYPE identityid) +{ + std::vector::iterator i=m_inserting.begin(); + while(i!=m_inserting.end() && (*i)!=identityid) + { + i++; + } + if(i!=m_inserting.end()) + { + m_inserting.erase(i); + } +} + +#endif // _iindexrequester_ diff --git a/include/freenet/iindexrequester.h b/include/freenet/iindexrequester.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6ba9ae7 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/iindexrequester.h @@ -0,0 +1,193 @@ +#ifndef _iindexrequester_ +#define _iindexrequester_ + +#include "../idatabase.h" +#include "../ilogger.h" +#include "../datetime.h" +#include "../option.h" +#include "../stringfunctions.h" +#include "ifreenetregistrable.h" +#include "ifcpconnected.h" +#include "ifcpmessagehandler.h" +#include "iperiodicprocessor.h" + +template +class IIndexRequester:public IFreenetRegistrable,public IFCPConnected,public IFCPMessageHandler,public IPeriodicProcessor,public IDatabase,public ILogger +{ +public: + IIndexRequester(); + IIndexRequester(FCPv2 *fcp); + + virtual void FCPConnected(); + virtual void FCPDisconnected(); + virtual const bool HandleMessage(FCPMessage &message); + + virtual void Process(); + + virtual void RegisterWithThread(FreenetMasterThread *thread); + +protected: + void InitializeIIndexRequester(); + virtual void Initialize()=0; // initialize m_maxrequests and m_fcpuniquename + virtual void PopulateIDList()=0; + virtual void StartRequest(const IDTYPE &id)=0; + virtual const bool HandleAllData(FCPMessage &message)=0; + virtual const bool HandleGetFailed(FCPMessage &message)=0; + virtual void RemoveFromRequestList(const IDTYPE id); + + DateTime m_tempdate; + std::string m_messagebase; + std::map m_ids; // map of all ids we know and whether we have requested file from them yet + std::vector m_requesting; // list of ids we are currently requesting from + + // these MUST be populated by child class + long m_maxrequests; + std::string m_fcpuniquename; + +}; + +template +IIndexRequester::IIndexRequester() +{ + InitializeIIndexRequester(); +} + +template +IIndexRequester::IIndexRequester(FCPv2 *fcp):IFCPConnected(fcp) +{ + InitializeIIndexRequester(); +} + +template +void IIndexRequester::FCPConnected() +{ + // make sure variables have been initialized by the derived class + if(m_maxrequests==-1) + { + m_log->WriteLog(LogFile::LOGLEVEL_ERROR,"IIndexRequester::FCPConnected maxrequests not initialized correctly!"); + } + if(m_fcpuniquename=="") + { + m_log->WriteLog(LogFile::LOGLEVEL_ERROR,"IIndexRequester::FCPConnected fcpuniquename not initialized correctly!"); + } + if(m_fcpuniquename.find("|")!=std::string::npos) + { + m_log->WriteLog(LogFile::LOGLEVEL_ERROR,"IIndexRequester::FCPConnected fcpuniquename contains | character! This is not a valid character!"); + } + + m_requesting.clear(); + PopulateIDList(); +} + +template +void IIndexRequester::FCPDisconnected() +{ + +} + +template +const bool IIndexRequester::HandleMessage(FCPMessage &message) +{ + + if(message["Identifier"].find(m_fcpuniquename)==0) + { + if(message.GetName()=="DataFound") + { + return true; + } + + if(message.GetName()=="AllData") + { + return HandleAllData(message); + } + + if(message.GetName()=="GetFailed") + { + return HandleGetFailed(message); + } + + if(message.GetName()=="IdentifierCollision") + { + // remove one of the ids from the requesting list + IDTYPE id; + std::vector idparts; + StringFunctions::Split(message["Identifier"],"|",idparts); + StringFunctions::Convert(idparts[1],id); + RemoveFromRequestList(id); + return true; + } + } + + return false; +} + +template +void IIndexRequester::InitializeIIndexRequester() +{ + m_maxrequests=-1; + m_fcpuniquename=""; + + Option::instance()->Get("MessageBase",m_messagebase); + m_tempdate.SetToGMTime(); +} + +template +void IIndexRequester::Process() +{ + // max is the smaller of the config value or the total number of identities we will request from + long max=m_maxrequests>m_ids.size() ? m_ids.size() : m_maxrequests; + + // try to keep up to max requests going + if(m_requesting.size()::iterator i=m_ids.begin(); + while(i!=m_ids.end() && (*i).second==true) + { + i++; + } + + if(i!=m_ids.end()) + { + StartRequest((*i).first); + } + else + { + // we requested from all ids in the list, repopulate the list + PopulateIDList(); + } + } + // special case - if there were 0 ids on the list when we started then we will never get a chance to repopulate the list + // this will recheck for ids every minute + DateTime now; + now.SetToGMTime(); + if(m_tempdate<(now-(1.0/1440.0))) + { + PopulateIDList(); + m_tempdate=now; + } + +} + +template +void IIndexRequester::RegisterWithThread(FreenetMasterThread *thread) +{ + thread->RegisterFCPConnected(this); + thread->RegisterFCPMessageHandler(this); + thread->RegisterPeriodicProcessor(this); +} + +template +void IIndexRequester::RemoveFromRequestList(const IDTYPE id) +{ + std::vector::iterator i=m_requesting.begin(); + while(i!=m_requesting.end() && (*i)!=id) + { + i++; + } + if(i!=m_requesting.end()) + { + m_requesting.erase(i); + } +} + +#endif // _iindexrequester_ diff --git a/include/freenet/messageinserter.h b/include/freenet/messageinserter.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b762157 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/messageinserter.h @@ -0,0 +1,22 @@ +#ifndef _messageinserter_ +#define _messageinserter_ + +#include "iindexinserter.h" + +// only handle 1 insert at a time +class MessageInserter:public IIndexInserter +{ +public: + MessageInserter(); + MessageInserter(FCPv2 *fcp); + +private: + void Initialize(); + const bool HandlePutSuccessful(FCPMessage &message); + const bool HandlePutFailed(FCPMessage &message); + void StartInsert(const std::string &messageuuid); + void CheckForNeededInsert(); + +}; + +#endif // _messageinserter_ diff --git a/include/freenet/messagelistinserter.h b/include/freenet/messagelistinserter.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a0564d3 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/messagelistinserter.h @@ -0,0 +1,23 @@ +#ifndef _messagelistinserter_ +#define _messagelistinserter_ + +#include "iindexinserter.h" + +class MessageListInserter:public IIndexInserter +{ +public: + MessageListInserter(); + MessageListInserter(FCPv2 *fcp); + +private: + void Initialize(); + const bool HandlePutSuccessful(FCPMessage &message); + const bool HandlePutFailed(FCPMessage &message); + void StartInsert(const long &localidentityid); + void CheckForNeededInsert(); + + long m_daysbackward; + +}; + +#endif // _messagelistinserter_ diff --git a/include/freenet/messagelistrequester.h b/include/freenet/messagelistrequester.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..56895e2 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/messagelistrequester.h @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +#ifndef _messagelistrequester_ +#define _messagelistrequester_ + +#include "iindexrequester.h" + +class MessageListRequester:public IIndexRequester +{ +public: + MessageListRequester(); + MessageListRequester(FCPv2 *fcp); + +private: + void Initialize(); + void PopulateIDList(); + void StartRequest(const long &id); + const bool HandleAllData(FCPMessage &message); + const bool HandleGetFailed(FCPMessage &message); + +}; + +#endif // _messagelistrequester_ diff --git a/include/freenet/messagelistxml.h b/include/freenet/messagelistxml.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..54d4998 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/messagelistxml.h @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ +#ifndef _messagelistxml_ +#define _messagelistxml_ + +#include "../ifmsxmldocument.h" + +#include + +class MessageListXML:public IFMSXMLDocument +{ +public: + MessageListXML(); + + std::string GetXML(); + const bool ParseXML(const std::string &xml); + + void ClearMessages() { m_messages.clear(); } + + void AddMessage(const std::string &date, const long index, const std::vector boards); + + const long MessageCount() { return m_messages.size(); } + std::string GetDate(const long index); + const long GetIndex(const long index); + std::vector GetBoards(const long index); + +private: + struct message + { + message(const std::string &date, const long index, const std::vector &boards):m_date(date),m_index(index),m_boards(boards) {} + std::string m_date; + long m_index; + std::vector m_boards; + }; + + void Initialize(); + + std::vector m_messages; + +}; + +#endif // _messagelistxml_ diff --git a/include/freenet/messagerequester.h b/include/freenet/messagerequester.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d40710f --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/messagerequester.h @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +#ifndef _messagerequester_ +#define _messagerequester_ + +#include "iindexrequester.h" + +class MessageRequester:public IIndexRequester +{ +public: + MessageRequester(); + MessageRequester(FCPv2 *fcp); + +private: + void Initialize(); + void PopulateIDList(); + void StartRequest(const std::string &requestid); + const bool HandleAllData(FCPMessage &message); + const bool HandleGetFailed(FCPMessage &message); + + const long GetBoardID(const std::string &boardname); + const std::string GetIdentityName(const long identityid); + + long m_maxdaysbackward; + +}; + +#endif // _messagerequester_ diff --git a/include/freenet/messagexml.h b/include/freenet/messagexml.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..04f97e2 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/freenet/messagexml.h @@ -0,0 +1,49 @@ +#ifndef _messagexml_ +#define _messagexml_ + +#include "../ifmsxmldocument.h" +#include +#include + +class MessageXML:public IFMSXMLDocument +{ +public: + + MessageXML(); + + std::string GetXML(); + const bool ParseXML(const std::string &xml); + + std::string GetDate() { return m_date; } + std::string GetTime() { return m_time; } + std::string GetSubject() { return m_subject; } + std::string GetMessageID() { return m_messageid; } + std::string GetReplyBoard() { return m_replyboard; } + std::string GetBody() { return m_body; } + std::vector GetBoards() { return m_boards; } + std::map GetInReplyTo() { return m_inreplyto; } + + void SetDate(const std::string &date) { m_date=date; } + void SetTime(const std::string &time) { m_time=time; } + void SetSubject(const std::string &subject) { m_subject=subject; } + void SetMessageID(const std::string &messageid) { m_messageid=messageid; } + void SetReplyBoard(const std::string &replyboard) { m_replyboard=replyboard; } + void SetBody(const std::string &body) { m_body=body; } + void AddBoard(const std::string &board) { m_boards.push_back(board); } + void AddInReplyTo(const long index, const std::string &messageid) { m_inreplyto[index]=messageid; } + +private: + void Initialize(); + + std::string m_date; + std::string m_time; + std::string m_subject; + std::string m_messageid; + std::vector m_boards; + std::string m_replyboard; + std::map m_inreplyto; + std::string m_body; + +}; + +#endif // _messagexml_ diff --git a/include/global.h b/include/global.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b823d73 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/global.h @@ -0,0 +1,24 @@ +#ifndef _global_ +#define _global_ + +#include +#include + +#define FMS_VERSION "0.1.0" + +// opens database and creates tables and initial inserts if necessary +void SetupDB(); +// inserts default options into the database +void SetupDefaultOptions(); +// opens logfile and sets it up +void SetupLogFile(); + +void StartThreads(std::vector &threads); +void ShutdownThreads(std::vector &threads); + +// needed for Windows to setup network +void SetupNetwork(); +// cleanup network on Windows +void ShutdownNetwork(); + +#endif // _global_ diff --git a/include/hex.h b/include/hex.h index a57bf6e..60cc871 100644 --- a/include/hex.h +++ b/include/hex.h @@ -12,4 +12,4 @@ const bool Decode(const std::string &encoded, std::vector &data); }; -#endif _hex_funcs_ +#endif // _hex_funcs_ diff --git a/include/identitytestglobal.h b/include/identitytestglobal.h deleted file mode 100644 index 17f6278..0000000 --- a/include/identitytestglobal.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,24 +0,0 @@ -#ifndef _global_ -#define _global_ - -#include -#include - -#define FMS_VERSION "0.0.4" - -// opens database and creates tables and initial inserts if necessary -void SetupDB(); -// inserts default options into the database -void SetupDefaultOptions(); -// opens logfile and sets it up -void SetupLogFile(); - -void StartThreads(std::vector &threads); -void ShutdownThreads(std::vector &threads); - -// needed for Windows to setup network -void SetupNetwork(); -// cleanup network on Windows -void ShutdownNetwork(); - -#endif // _global_ diff --git a/include/ifmsxmldocument.h b/include/ifmsxmldocument.h index 24484ec..f444af5 100644 --- a/include/ifmsxmldocument.h +++ b/include/ifmsxmldocument.h @@ -1,6 +1,8 @@ #ifndef _ifmsxmldocument_ #define _ifmsxmldocument_ +#include "stringfunctions.h" + #include #include @@ -60,6 +62,13 @@ protected: return el; } + virtual TiXmlElement *XMLCreateTextElement(const std::string &name, const long data) + { + std::string datastr; + StringFunctions::Convert(data,datastr); + return XMLCreateTextElement(name,datastr); + } + virtual const bool XMLGetBooleanElement(TiXmlElement *parent, const std::string &name) { TiXmlHandle hnd(parent); diff --git a/include/message.h b/include/message.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..1fe1216 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/message.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +#ifndef _message_ +#define _message_ + +#include "idatabase.h" +#include "ilogger.h" +#include "datetime.h" + +class Message:public IDatabase,public ILogger +{ +public: + Message(); + Message(const long messageid); + Message(const std::string &messageuuid); + + const long GetMessageID() const { return m_messageid; } + const std::string GetMessageUUID() const { return m_messageuuid; } + const std::string GetSubject() const { return m_subject; } + const std::string GetBody() const { return m_body; } + const std::string GetReplyBoardName() { return m_replyboardname; } + const DateTime GetDateTime() const { return m_datetime; } + const std::string GetFromName() const { return m_fromname; } + std::vector GetBoards() const { return m_boards; } + std::map GetInReplyTo() const { return m_inreplyto; } + + const std::string GetNNTPHeaders() const; + const std::string GetNNTPArticleID() const; + const std::string GetNNTPBody() const; + +/* + void SetMessageUUID(const std::string &messageuuid) { m_messageuuid=messageuuid; } + void SetSubject(const std::string &subject) { m_subject=subject; } + void SetBody(const std::string &body) { m_body=body; } + void SetReplyBoardName(const std::string &replyboardname) { m_replyboardname=replyboardname; } + void SetDateTime(const DateTime &datetime) { m_datetime=datetime; } + void SetFromName(const std::string &fromname) { m_fromname=fromname; } + void AddBoard(const std::string &board) { m_boards.push_back(board); } + void AddInReplyTo(const long index, const std::string &messageid) { m_inreplyto[index]=messageid; } +*/ + + const bool Load(const long messageid, const long boardid=-1); + const bool LoadNext(const long messageid, const long boardid=-1); // loads next message in board with messageid > passed id + const bool LoadPrevious(const long messageid, const long boardid=-1); // loads previous message in board with messageid < passed id + const bool Load(const std::string &messageuuid); + + const bool ParseNNTPMessage(const std::string &nntpmessage); + + void StartFreenetInsert(); + +private: + void Initialize(); + + long m_messageid; + std::string m_messageuuid; + std::string m_subject; + std::string m_body; + std::string m_replyboardname; + DateTime m_datetime; + std::string m_fromname; + std::vector m_boards; + std::map m_inreplyto; + +}; + +#endif // _message_ diff --git a/include/messagelist.h b/include/messagelist.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..aa12bee --- /dev/null +++ b/include/messagelist.h @@ -0,0 +1,21 @@ +#ifndef _messagelist_ +#define _messagelist_ + +#include "message.h" +#include "ilogger.h" +#include "idatabase.h" + +class MessageList:public std::vector,public ILogger,public IDatabase +{ +public: + + /** + \brief Loads all messages with an id between lowmessageid and highmessageid inclusive + */ + void LoadRange(const long lowmessageid, const long highmessageid, const long boardid=-1); + +private: + +}; + +#endif // _messagelist_ \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/include/nntp/mime/Mime.h b/include/nntp/mime/Mime.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a4ca304 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/nntp/mime/Mime.h @@ -0,0 +1,496 @@ +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// MIME message encoding/decoding +// +// Jeff Lee +// Dec 11, 2000 +// +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// + +#if !defined(_MIME_H) +#define _MIME_H + +#if _MSC_VER > 1000 +#pragma once +#endif // _MSC_VER > 1000 + +#include +#include +using namespace std; + +// RFC 1521 - Mechanisms for Specifying and Describing the Format of Internet Message Bodies +// RFC 2045 - Format of Internet Message Bodies +// RFC 2046 - Media Types +// RFC 2047 - Message Header Extensions for Non-ASCII Text +// RFC 2049 - Conformance Criteria and Examples +// RFC 822 - Standard For The Format of ARPA Internet Text Message + +class CMimeConst +{ +public: + // field names + static inline const char* MimeVersion() { return "MIME-Version"; } + static inline const char* ContentType() { return "Content-Type"; } + static inline const char* TransferEncoding() { return "Content-Transfer-Encoding"; } + static inline const char* ContentID() { return "Content-ID"; } + static inline const char* ContentDescription() { return "Content-Description"; } + static inline const char* ContentDisposition() { return "Content-Disposition"; } + + // parameter names + static inline const char* Charset() { return "charset"; } + static inline const char* Name() { return "name"; } + static inline const char* Filename() { return "filename"; } + static inline const char* Boundary() { return "boundary"; } + + // parameter values + static inline const char* Encoding7Bit() { return "7bit"; } + static inline const char* Encoding8Bit() { return "8bit"; } + static inline const char* EncodingBinary() { return "binary"; } + static inline const char* EncodingQP() { return "quoted-printable"; } + static inline const char* EncodingBase64() { return "base64"; } + + static inline const char* MediaText() { return "text"; } + static inline const char* MediaImage() { return "image"; } + static inline const char* MediaAudio() { return "audio"; } + static inline const char* MediaVedio() { return "vedio"; } + static inline const char* MediaApplication() { return "application"; } + static inline const char* MediaMultiPart() { return "multipart"; } + static inline const char* MediaMessage() { return "message"; } +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeField class - Represents a field of a MIME body part header +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeField +{ +public: + CMimeField() {} + ~CMimeField() {} + +public: + void SetName(const char* pszName); + const char* GetName() const; + void SetValue(const char* pszValue); + const char* GetValue() const; + void GetValue(string& strValue) const; + void SetParameter(const char* pszAttr, const char* pszValue); + bool GetParameter(const char* pszAttr, string& strValue) const; + void SetCharset(const char* pszCharset); + const char* GetCharset() const; + + void Clear(); + int GetLength() const; + int Store(char* pszData, int nMaxSize) const; + int Load(const char* pszData, int nDataSize); + +private: + string m_strName; // field name + string m_strValue; // field value + string m_strCharset; // charset for non-ascii text + +private: + bool FindParameter(const char* pszAttr, int& nPos, int& nSize) const; +}; + +inline void CMimeField::SetName(const char* pszName) +{ m_strName = pszName; } + +inline const char* CMimeField::GetName() const +{ return m_strName.data(); } + +inline void CMimeField::SetValue(const char* pszValue) +{ m_strValue = pszValue; } + +inline const char* CMimeField::GetValue() const +{ return m_strValue.data(); } + +inline void CMimeField::SetCharset(const char* pszCharset) +{ m_strCharset = pszCharset; } + +inline const char* CMimeField::GetCharset() const +{ return m_strCharset.c_str(); } + +inline void CMimeField::Clear() +{ m_strName.clear(); m_strValue.clear(); m_strCharset.clear(); } + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeHeader class - Represents the header of a MIME body part +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeHeader +{ +public: + CMimeHeader() {} + virtual ~CMimeHeader() { Clear(); } + +public: + enum MediaType + { + MEDIA_TEXT, MEDIA_IMAGE, MEDIA_AUDIO, MEDIA_VEDIO, MEDIA_APPLICATION, + MEDIA_MULTIPART, MEDIA_MESSAGE, + MEDIA_UNKNOWN + }; + MediaType GetMediaType() const; + + // set/get the values of header fields + void SetField(const CMimeField& field); + const CMimeField* GetField(const char* pszFieldName) const; + CMimeField* GetField(const char* pszFieldName); + void SetFieldValue(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszFieldValue, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetFieldValue(const char* pszFieldName) const; + bool SetParameter(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszAttr, const char* pszValue); + string GetParameter(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszAttr) const; + void SetFieldCharset(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszCharset); + const char* GetFieldCharset(const char* pszFieldName) const; + + // helper functions for standard body part fields + void SetContentType(const char* pszValue, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetContentType() const; // Content-Type: mediatype/subtype + string GetMainType() const; + string GetSubType() const; + void SetCharset(const char* pszCharset); // Content-Type: text/...; charset=... + string GetCharset() const; + void SetName(const char* pszName); // Content-Type: image/...; name=... + string GetName() const; + void SetBoundary(const char* pszBoundary=NULL); // Content-Type: multipart/...; boundary=... + string GetBoundary() const; + + void SetTransferEncoding(const char* pszValue); + const char* GetTransferEncoding() const; // Content-Transfer-Encoding: ... + void SetDisposition(const char* pszValue, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetDisposition() const; // Content-Disposition: ... + string GetFilename() const; // Content-Disposition: ...; filename=... + void SetDescription(const char* pszValue, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetDescription() const; // Content-Description: ... + + typedef list CFieldList; + CFieldList& Fields() { return m_listFields; } + +public: + // overrides + virtual void Clear(); + virtual int GetLength() const; + // serialization + virtual int Store(char* pszData, int nMaxSize) const; + virtual int Load(const char* pszData, int nDataSize); + +protected: + list m_listFields; // list of all header fields + list::const_iterator FindField(const char* pszFieldName) const; + list::iterator FindField(const char* pszFieldName); + + struct MediaTypeCvt + { + int nMediaType; // media type + const char* pszSubType; // subtype + const char* pszFileExt; // file extension name + }; + static const MediaTypeCvt m_TypeCvtTable[]; + static const char* m_TypeTable[]; + +private: + CMimeHeader& operator=(const CMimeHeader&); // forbid operator = +}; + +// add a new field or update an existing field +inline void CMimeHeader::SetField(const CMimeField& field) +{ + list::iterator it = FindField(field.GetName()); + if (it != m_listFields.end()) + *it = field; + else + m_listFields.push_back(field); +} + +// find a field by name +inline const CMimeField* CMimeHeader::GetField(const char* pszFieldName) const +{ + list::const_iterator it = FindField(pszFieldName); + if (it != m_listFields.end()) + return &(*it); + return NULL; +} + +inline CMimeField* CMimeHeader::GetField(const char* pszFieldName) +{ + list::iterator it = FindField(pszFieldName); + if (it != m_listFields.end()) + return &(*it); + return NULL; +} + +// add a new field or update an existing field +inline void CMimeHeader::SetFieldValue(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszFieldValue, const char* pszCharset) +{ + CMimeField fd; + fd.SetName(pszFieldName); + fd.SetValue(pszFieldValue); + if (pszCharset != NULL) + fd.SetCharset(pszCharset); + SetField(fd); +} + +inline const char* CMimeHeader::GetFieldValue(const char* pszFieldName) const +{ + const CMimeField* pfd = GetField(pszFieldName); + return pfd != NULL ? pfd->GetValue() : NULL; +} + +inline void CMimeHeader::SetFieldCharset(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszCharset) +{ + CMimeField *pfd = GetField(pszFieldName); + if (pfd) + pfd->SetCharset(pszCharset); + else + { + CMimeField fd; + fd.SetName(pszFieldName); + fd.SetCharset(pszCharset); + SetField(fd); + } +} + +inline const char* CMimeHeader::GetFieldCharset(const char* pszFieldName) const +{ + const CMimeField* pfd = GetField(pszFieldName); + return pfd != NULL ? pfd->GetCharset() : NULL; +} + +inline bool CMimeHeader::SetParameter(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszAttr, const char* pszValue) +{ + CMimeField *pfd = GetField(pszFieldName); + if (pfd) + { + pfd->SetParameter(pszAttr, pszValue); + return true; + } + return false; +} + +inline string CMimeHeader::GetParameter(const char* pszFieldName, const char* pszAttr) const +{ + string strVal; + const CMimeField *pfd = GetField(pszFieldName); + if (pfd) + pfd->GetParameter(pszAttr, strVal); + return strVal; +} + +inline void CMimeHeader::SetContentType(const char* pszValue, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue(CMimeConst::ContentType(), pszValue, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeHeader::GetContentType() const +{ return GetFieldValue(CMimeConst::ContentType()); } + +inline string CMimeHeader::GetCharset() const +{ return GetParameter(CMimeConst::ContentType(), CMimeConst::Charset()); } + +inline string CMimeHeader::GetName() const +{ return GetParameter(CMimeConst::ContentType(), CMimeConst::Name()); } + +inline string CMimeHeader::GetBoundary() const +{ return GetParameter(CMimeConst::ContentType(), CMimeConst::Boundary()); } + +inline void CMimeHeader::SetTransferEncoding(const char* pszValue) +{ SetFieldValue(CMimeConst::TransferEncoding(), pszValue); } + +inline const char* CMimeHeader::GetTransferEncoding() const +{ return GetFieldValue(CMimeConst::TransferEncoding()); } + +// Content-Disposition header field specifies how to present this body part. it could be +// inline or attachment. 'inline' indicates this body part should be displayed in the main body; +// 'attachment' indicates it is separate from the main body. (RFC 2183) + +inline void CMimeHeader::SetDisposition(const char* pszValue, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue(CMimeConst::ContentDisposition(), pszValue, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeHeader::GetDisposition() const +{ return GetFieldValue(CMimeConst::ContentDisposition()); } + +inline string CMimeHeader::GetFilename() const +{ return GetParameter(CMimeConst::ContentDisposition(), CMimeConst::Filename()); } + +inline void CMimeHeader::SetDescription(const char* pszValue, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue(CMimeConst::ContentDescription(), pszValue, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeHeader::GetDescription() const +{ return GetFieldValue(CMimeConst::ContentDescription()); } + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeBody class - Represents a body part in a MIME message +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeMessage; +class CMimeBody : public CMimeHeader +{ +protected: + CMimeBody() : // instantiate a CMimeBody object explicitly is not allowed. call CreatePart() + m_pbText(NULL), + m_nTextSize(0) {} + virtual ~CMimeBody() { Clear(); } + +public: + int GetContentLength() const; + const unsigned char* GetContent() const; + + // operations for 'text' or 'message' media + bool IsText() const; + int SetText(const char* pbText, int nLength=0); + int GetText(char* pbText, int nMaxSize); + int GetText(string& strText); + + // operations for 'message' media + bool IsMessage() const; + bool SetMessage(const CMimeMessage* pMM); + void GetMessage(CMimeMessage* pMM) const; + + // operations for 'image/audio/vedio/application' (attachment) media + bool IsAttachment() const; + bool ReadFromFile(const char* pszFilename); + bool WriteToFile(const char* pszFilename); + + // operations for 'multipart' media + bool IsMultiPart() const; + void DeleteAll(); + CMimeBody* CreatePart(const char* pszMediaType=NULL, CMimeBody* pWhere=NULL); + void ErasePart(CMimeBody* pBP); + CMimeBody* FindFirstPart(); + CMimeBody* FindNextPart(); + + typedef list CBodyList; + int GetBodyPartList(CBodyList& rList) const; + int GetAttachmentList(CBodyList& rList) const; + +public: + // overrides + virtual void Clear(); + virtual int GetLength() const; + // serialization + virtual int Store(char* pszData, int nMaxSize) const; + virtual void Store(std::string &str) const; + virtual int Load(const char* pszData, int nDataSize); + +protected: + unsigned char* m_pbText; // content (text) of the body part + int m_nTextSize; // length of content + CBodyList m_listBodies; // list of all child body parts + CBodyList::iterator m_itFind; + +protected: + bool AllocateBuffer(int nBufSize); + void FreeBuffer(); + + friend class CMimeEnvironment; +}; + +inline int CMimeBody::GetContentLength() const +{ return m_nTextSize; } + +inline const unsigned char* CMimeBody::GetContent() const +{ return m_pbText; } + +inline bool CMimeBody::IsText() const +{ return GetMediaType() == MEDIA_TEXT; } + +inline bool CMimeBody::IsMessage() const +{ return GetMediaType() == MEDIA_MESSAGE; } + +inline bool CMimeBody::IsAttachment() const +{ return GetName().size() > 0; } + +inline bool CMimeBody::IsMultiPart() const +{ return GetMediaType() == MEDIA_MULTIPART; } + +inline CMimeBody* CMimeBody::FindFirstPart() +{ + m_itFind = m_listBodies.begin(); + return FindNextPart(); +} + +inline CMimeBody* CMimeBody::FindNextPart() +{ + if (m_itFind != m_listBodies.end()) + return *m_itFind++; + return NULL; +} + +inline bool CMimeBody::AllocateBuffer(int nBufSize) +{ + FreeBuffer(); + m_pbText = new unsigned char[nBufSize]; + if (!m_pbText) return false; + m_nTextSize = nBufSize; + return true; +} + +inline void CMimeBody::FreeBuffer() +{ + delete []m_pbText; + m_pbText = NULL; + m_nTextSize = 0; +} + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeMessage - Represents a MIME message +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeMessage : public CMimeBody +{ +public: + CMimeMessage() { /*SetVersion();*/ } + virtual ~CMimeMessage() { Clear(); } + +public: + // set/get RFC 822 message header fields + void SetFrom(const char* pszFrom, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetFrom() const; + void SetTo(const char* pszTo, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetTo() const; + void SetCc(const char* pszCc, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetCc() const; + void SetBcc(const char* pszBcc, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetBcc() const; + + void SetSubject(const char* pszSubject, const char* pszCharset=NULL); + const char* GetSubject() const; + + void SetDate(); + void SetDate(int nYear, int nMonth, int nDay, int nHour, int nMinute, int nSecond); + const char* GetDate() const; + void SetVersion(); +}; + +inline void CMimeMessage::SetFrom(const char* pszAddr, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue("From", pszAddr, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeMessage::GetFrom() const +{ return GetFieldValue("From"); } + +inline void CMimeMessage::SetTo(const char* pszAddr, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue("To", pszAddr, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeMessage::GetTo() const +{ return GetFieldValue("To"); } + +inline void CMimeMessage::SetCc(const char* pszAddr, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue("CC", pszAddr, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeMessage::GetCc() const +{ return GetFieldValue("CC"); } + +inline void CMimeMessage::SetBcc(const char* pszAddr, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue("BCC", pszAddr, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeMessage::GetBcc() const +{ return GetFieldValue("BCC"); } + +inline void CMimeMessage::SetSubject(const char* pszSubject, const char* pszCharset) +{ SetFieldValue("Subject", pszSubject, pszCharset); } + +inline const char* CMimeMessage::GetSubject() const +{ return GetFieldValue("Subject"); } + +inline const char* CMimeMessage::GetDate() const +{ return GetFieldValue("Date"); } + +inline void CMimeMessage::SetVersion() +{ SetFieldValue(CMimeConst::MimeVersion(), "1.0"); } + +#endif // !defined(_MIME_H) diff --git a/include/nntp/mime/MimeChar.h b/include/nntp/mime/MimeChar.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b334b00 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/nntp/mime/MimeChar.h @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// MIME Character Classification +// +// Jeff Lee +// Dec 16, 2000 +// +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// + +#if !defined(_MIME_CHAR_H) +#define _MIME_CHAR_H + +#if _MSC_VER > 1000 +#pragma once +#endif // _MSC_VER > 1000 + +class CMimeChar +{ +public: + static bool IsNonAscii(unsigned char ch) { return (ch & 0x80) != 0; } + static bool IsControl(unsigned char ch) { return !(ch & 0x80) && (m_aCharTbl[ch] & CONTROL) != 0; } + static bool IsSpace(unsigned char ch) { return !(ch & 0x80) && (m_aCharTbl[ch] & SPACE) != 0; } + static bool IsPrintable(unsigned char ch) { return !(ch & 0x80) && (m_aCharTbl[ch] & PRINT) != 0; } + static bool IsSpecial(unsigned char ch) { return !(ch & 0x80) && (m_aCharTbl[ch] & SPECIAL) != 0; } + static bool IsHexDigit(unsigned char ch) { return !(ch & 0x80) && (m_aCharTbl[ch] & HEXDIGIT) != 0; } + static bool IsDelimiter(unsigned char ch) { return IsSpace(ch) || IsSpecial(ch); } + static bool IsToken(unsigned char ch) { return IsNonAscii(ch) || (ch > ' ' && !IsSpecial(ch)); } + +private: + enum { CONTROL=0x01, SPACE=0x02, PRINT=0x04, PUNCT=0x10, SPECIAL=0x20, HEXDIGIT=0x40 }; + static const unsigned char m_aCharTbl[128]; +}; + +#endif // _MIME_CHAR_H \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/include/nntp/mime/MimeCode.h b/include/nntp/mime/MimeCode.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..0b828df --- /dev/null +++ b/include/nntp/mime/MimeCode.h @@ -0,0 +1,335 @@ +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// +// MIME Encoding/Decoding: +// Quoted-printable and Base64 for content encoding; +// Encoded-word for header field encoding. +// +// Jeff Lee +// Dec 11, 2000 +// +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// + +#if !defined(_MIME_CODING_H) +#define _MIME_CODING_H + +#if _MSC_VER > 1000 +#pragma once +#endif // _MSC_VER > 1000 + +#include +#include +#include +using namespace std; + +#pragma warning(disable:4786) // identifier was truncated to 'number' characters in the debug information + +#if !defined(ASSERT) +#if defined(_DEBUG) + #include + #define ASSERT(exp) assert(exp) +#else + #define ASSERT(exp) ((void)0) +#endif +#endif + +#if defined(_DEBUG) && !defined(DEBUG_NEW) +#define DEBUG_NEW new +#endif + +// maximum length of an encoded line (RFC 2045) +#define MAX_MIME_LINE_LEN 76 +#define MAX_ENCODEDWORD_LEN 75 + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeEnvironment - global environment to manage encoding/decoding +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeCodeBase; +class CFieldCodeBase; +class CMimeBody; +class CMimeEnvironment +{ +public: + CMimeEnvironment(); + +public: + // global options + static void SetAutoFolding(bool bAutoFolding=true); + static bool AutoFolding() { return m_bAutoFolding; } + static void SetGlobalCharset(const char* pszCharset) { m_strCharset = pszCharset; } + static const char* GetGlobalCharset() { return m_strCharset.c_str(); } + + // Content-Transfer-Encoding coder management + typedef CMimeCodeBase* (*CODER_FACTORY)(); + static void RegisterCoder(const char* pszCodingName, CODER_FACTORY pfnCreateObject=NULL); + static CMimeCodeBase* CreateCoder(const char* pszCodingName); + + // header fields encoding/folding management + typedef CFieldCodeBase* (*FIELD_CODER_FACTORY)(); + static void RegisterFieldCoder(const char* pszFieldName, FIELD_CODER_FACTORY pfnCreateObject=NULL); + static CFieldCodeBase* CreateFieldCoder(const char* pszFieldName); + + // media type management + typedef CMimeBody* (*BODY_PART_FACTORY)(); + static void RegisterMediaType(const char* pszMediaType, BODY_PART_FACTORY pfnCreateObject=NULL); + static CMimeBody* CreateBodyPart(const char* pszMediaType); + +private: + static bool m_bAutoFolding; + static string m_strCharset; + + typedef pair CODER_PAIR; + static list m_listCoders; + + typedef pair FIELD_CODER_PAIR; + static list m_listFieldCoders; + + typedef pair MEDIA_TYPE_PAIR; + static list m_listMediaTypes; + + static CMimeEnvironment m_globalMgr; +}; + +#define DECLARE_MIMECODER(class_name) \ + public: static CMimeCodeBase* CreateObject() { return new class_name; } + +#define REGISTER_MIMECODER(coding_name, class_name) \ + CMimeEnvironment::RegisterCoder(coding_name, class_name::CreateObject) + +#define DEREGISTER_MIMECODER(coding_name) \ + CMimeEnvironment::RegisterCoder(coding_name, 0) + +#define DECLARE_FIELDCODER(class_name) \ + public: static CFieldCodeBase* CreateObject() { return new class_name; } + +#define REGISTER_FIELDCODER(field_name, class_name) \ + CMimeEnvironment::RegisterFieldCoder(field_name, class_name::CreateObject) + +#define DEREGISTER_FIELDCODER(field_name) \ + CMimeEnvironment::RegisterFieldCoder(field_name, 0) + +#define DECLARE_MEDIATYPE(class_name) \ + public: static CMimeBody* CreateObject() { return new class_name; } + +#define REGISTER_MEDIATYPE(media_type, class_name) \ + CMimeEnvironment::RegisterMediaType(media_type, class_name::CreateObject) + +#define DEREGISTER_MEDIATYPE(media_type) \ + CMimeEnvironment::RegisterMediaType(media_type, 0) + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeCodeBase - base class for MIME encoding/decoding +// default implementation for binary/unknown encoding mechanism +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeCodeBase +{ +public: + CMimeCodeBase() : + m_pbInput(NULL), + m_nInputSize(0), + m_bIsEncoding(false) {} + +public: + void SetInput(const char* pbInput, int nInputSize, bool bEncoding) + { + m_pbInput = (const unsigned char*) pbInput; + m_nInputSize = nInputSize; + m_bIsEncoding = bEncoding; + } + int GetOutputLength() const + { + return m_bIsEncoding ? GetEncodeLength() : GetDecodeLength(); + } + int GetOutput(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) + { + return m_bIsEncoding ? Encode(pbOutput, nMaxSize) : Decode(pbOutput, nMaxSize); + } + +protected: + // overrides + virtual int GetEncodeLength() const { return m_nInputSize; } + virtual int GetDecodeLength() const { return m_nInputSize; } + virtual int Encode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const + { + int nSize = min(nMaxSize, m_nInputSize); + ::memcpy(pbOutput, m_pbInput, nSize); + return nSize; + } + virtual int Decode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) + { + return CMimeCodeBase::Encode(pbOutput, nMaxSize); + } + +protected: + const unsigned char* m_pbInput; + int m_nInputSize; + bool m_bIsEncoding; +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeCode7bit - for 7bit/8bit encoding mechanism (fold long line) +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeCode7bit : public CMimeCodeBase +{ + DECLARE_MIMECODER(CMimeCode7bit) + +protected: + virtual int GetEncodeLength() const; + virtual int Encode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeCodeQP - for quoted-printable encoding mechanism +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeCodeQP : public CMimeCodeBase +{ +public: + CMimeCodeQP() : + m_bQuoteLineBreak(false) {} + +public: + DECLARE_MIMECODER(CMimeCodeQP) + void QuoteLineBreak(bool bQuote=true) { m_bQuoteLineBreak = bQuote; } + +protected: + virtual int GetEncodeLength() const; + //virtual int GetDecodeLength() const; + virtual int Encode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; + virtual int Decode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize); + +private: + bool m_bQuoteLineBreak; +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeCodeBase64 - for base64 encoding mechanism +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeCodeBase64 : public CMimeCodeBase +{ +public: + CMimeCodeBase64() : + m_bAddLineBreak(true) {} + +public: + DECLARE_MIMECODER(CMimeCodeBase64) + void AddLineBreak(bool bAdd=true) { m_bAddLineBreak = bAdd; } + +protected: + virtual int GetEncodeLength() const; + virtual int GetDecodeLength() const; + virtual int Encode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; + virtual int Decode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize); + +private: + bool m_bAddLineBreak; + +private: + static inline int DecodeBase64Char(unsigned int nCode) + { + if (nCode >= 'A' && nCode <= 'Z') + return nCode - 'A'; + if (nCode >= 'a' && nCode <= 'z') + return nCode - 'a' + 26; + if (nCode >= '0' && nCode <= '9') + return nCode - '0' + 52; + if (nCode == '+') + return 62; + if (nCode == '/') + return 63; + return 64; + } +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CMimeEncodedWord - encoded word for non-ascii text (RFC 2047) +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CMimeEncodedWord : public CMimeCodeBase +{ +public: + CMimeEncodedWord() : + m_nEncoding(0) {} + + void SetEncoding(int nEncoding, const char* pszCharset) + { + m_nEncoding = nEncoding; + m_strCharset = pszCharset; + } + int GetEncoding() const { return m_nEncoding; } + const char* GetCharset() const { return m_strCharset.c_str(); } + +protected: + virtual int GetEncodeLength() const; + virtual int Encode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; + virtual int Decode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize); + +private: + int m_nEncoding; + string m_strCharset; + + int BEncode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; + int QEncode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CFieldCodeBase - base class to encode/decode header fields +// default coder for any unregistered fields +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CFieldCodeBase : public CMimeCodeBase +{ +public: + void SetCharset(const char* pszCharset) { m_strCharset = pszCharset; } + const char* GetCharset() const { return m_strCharset.c_str(); } + +protected: + string m_strCharset; + + virtual bool IsFoldingChar(char /*ch*/) const { return false; } + virtual int GetDelimeter() const { return 0; } + int FindSymbol(const char* pszData, int nSize, int& nDelimeter, int& nNonAscChars) const; + void UnfoldField(string& strField) const; + int SelectEncoding(int nLength, int nNonAsciiChars) const + { + int nQEncodeSize = nLength + nNonAsciiChars * 2; + int nBEncodeSize = (nLength + 2) / 3 * 4; + return (nQEncodeSize <= nBEncodeSize || nNonAsciiChars*5 <= nLength) ? 'Q' : 'B'; + } + +protected: + virtual int GetEncodeLength() const; + virtual int Encode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize) const; + virtual int Decode(unsigned char* pbOutput, int nMaxSize); +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CFieldCodeText - encode/decode header fields defined as *text +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CFieldCodeText : public CFieldCodeBase +{ + DECLARE_FIELDCODER(CFieldCodeText) + +protected: + virtual int GetDelimeter() const { return 0xff; } +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CFieldCodeAddress - encode/decode header fields defined as address +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CFieldCodeAddress : public CFieldCodeBase +{ + DECLARE_FIELDCODER(CFieldCodeAddress) + +protected: + virtual bool IsFoldingChar(char ch) const { return ch == ',' || ch == ':'; } +}; + +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +// CFieldCodeParameter - encode/decode header fields have parameters +////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////// +class CFieldCodeParameter : public CFieldCodeBase +{ + DECLARE_FIELDCODER(CFieldCodeParameter) + +protected: + virtual bool IsFoldingChar(char ch) const { return ch == ';'; } +}; + +#endif // !defined(_MIME_CODING_H) diff --git a/include/nntp/nntpconnection.h b/include/nntp/nntpconnection.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d2bf167 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/nntp/nntpconnection.h @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +#ifndef _nntpconnection_ +#define _nntpconnection_ + +#include "../socketdefines.h" +#include "../ilogger.h" +#include "../message.h" + +#include +#include +#include + +class NNTPConnection:public ZThread::Runnable,public ILogger//,public IDatabase +{ +public: + NNTPConnection(SOCKET sock); + ~NNTPConnection(); + + void Disconnect(); + const bool Disconnected() { return m_socket==INVALID_SOCKET; } + + void run(); + +private: + + typedef enum ClientMode + { + MODE_NONE=0, + MODE_READER + }; + struct NNTPCommand + { + std::string m_command; + std::vector m_arguments; + }; + struct ClientStatus + { + ClientMode m_mode; + bool m_allowpost; + bool m_isposting; + long m_boardid; + long m_messageid; + }; + + void SendBuffered(const std::string &data); + void SendBufferedLine(const std::string &data) { SendBuffered(data+"\r\n"); } + void SocketSend(); // immediately send buffered data - will block if send if no ready + void SocketReceive(); // immediately recv data on socket - will block if no data is waiting + void HandleReceivedData(); + std::vector::iterator Find(std::vector &buffer, const std::string &val); + const bool HandleCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + void HandlePostedMessage(const std::string &message); + + void SendArticleParts(const NNTPCommand &command); + void SendArticleOverInfo(const Message &message); + + // various NNTP commands to handle + const bool HandleQuitCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleModeCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleCapabilitiesCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleHelpCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleDateCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleListCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleGroupCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleListGroupCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleNextCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleLastCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleArticleCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleHeadCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleBodyCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleStatCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleNewGroupsCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandlePostCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + const bool HandleOverCommand(const NNTPCommand &command); + + SOCKET m_socket; + ClientStatus m_status; + std::vector m_sendbuffer; + std::vector m_receivebuffer; + std::vector m_tempbuffer; + +}; + +#endif // _nntpconnection_ diff --git a/include/nntp/nntplistener.h b/include/nntp/nntplistener.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e74ca9c --- /dev/null +++ b/include/nntp/nntplistener.h @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +#ifndef _nntp_listener_ +#define _nntp_listener_ + +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include + +#include "../socketdefines.h" + +/** + \brief Listens for NNTP connections +*/ +class NNTPListener:public ZThread::Runnable +{ +public: + NNTPListener(); + ~NNTPListener(); + + void run(); + void StartListen(); + +private: + + unsigned short m_listenport; + std::vector m_listensockets; + ZThread::ThreadedExecutor m_connections; + +}; + +#endif // _nntp_listener_ diff --git a/include/nntp/uwildmat.h b/include/nntp/uwildmat.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e999113 --- /dev/null +++ b/include/nntp/uwildmat.h @@ -0,0 +1,17 @@ +#ifndef _uwildmat_ +#define _uwildmat_ + +#include "../pstdint.h" + +/* +** WILDMAT MATCHING +*/ +enum uwildmat { + UWILDMAT_FAIL = 0, + UWILDMAT_MATCH = 1, + UWILDMAT_POISON +}; + +bool uwildmat(const char *text, const char *pat); + +#endif // _uwildmat_ diff --git a/include/stringfunctions.h b/include/stringfunctions.h index 5222ca1..ac803c9 100644 --- a/include/stringfunctions.h +++ b/include/stringfunctions.h @@ -8,6 +8,12 @@ namespace StringFunctions { +inline const bool Convert(const std::string &input, std::string &output) +{ + output=input; + return true; +} + /** \brief Converts a string into any other type \param input[in] string to convert diff --git a/include/xyssl/sha1.h b/include/xyssl/sha1.h index 0c6b03e..a182625 100644 --- a/include/xyssl/sha1.h +++ b/include/xyssl/sha1.h @@ -116,4 +116,4 @@ int sha1_self_test( int verbose ); } #endif -#endif /* sha1.h */ \ No newline at end of file +#endif /* sha1.h */ diff --git a/libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.c b/libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..bf9ddaa --- /dev/null +++ b/libs/sqlite3/sqlite3.c @@ -0,0 +1,113931 @@ +/****************************************************************************** +** This file is an amalgamation of many separate C source files from SQLite +** version 3.5.4. By combining all the individual C code files into this +** single large file, the entire code can be compiled as a one translation +** unit. This allows many compilers to do optimizations that would not be +** possible if the files were compiled separately. Performance improvements +** of 5% are more are commonly seen when SQLite is compiled as a single +** translation unit. +** +** This file is all you need to compile SQLite. To use SQLite in other +** programs, you need this file and the "sqlite3.h" header file that defines +** the programming interface to the SQLite library. (If you do not have +** the "sqlite3.h" header file at hand, you will find a copy in the first +** 3840 lines past this header comment.) Additional code files may be +** needed if you want a wrapper to interface SQLite with your choice of +** programming language. The code for the "sqlite3" command-line shell +** is also in a separate file. This file contains only code for the core +** SQLite library. +** +** This amalgamation was generated on 2007-12-14 17:40:56 UTC. +*/ +#define SQLITE_AMALGAMATION 1 +#ifndef SQLITE_PRIVATE +# define SQLITE_PRIVATE static +#endif +#ifndef SQLITE_API +# define SQLITE_API +#endif +/************** Begin file sqliteInt.h ***************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 15 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** Internal interface definitions for SQLite. +** +** @(#) $Id: sqliteInt.h,v 1.626 2007/12/13 03:45:08 drh Exp $ +*/ +#ifndef _SQLITEINT_H_ +#define _SQLITEINT_H_ + +/* +** The macro unlikely() is a hint that surrounds a boolean +** expression that is usually false. Macro likely() surrounds +** a boolean expression that is usually true. GCC is able to +** use these hints to generate better code, sometimes. +*/ +#if defined(__GNUC__) +# define likely(X) __builtin_expect((X),1) +# define unlikely(X) __builtin_expect((X),0) +#else +# define likely(X) !!(X) +# define unlikely(X) !!(X) +#endif + + +/* +** These #defines should enable >2GB file support on Posix if the +** underlying operating system supports it. If the OS lacks +** large file support, or if the OS is windows, these should be no-ops. +** +** Ticket #2739: The _LARGEFILE_SOURCE macro must appear before any +** system #includes. Hence, this block of code must be the very first +** code in all source files. +** +** Large file support can be disabled using the -DSQLITE_DISABLE_LFS switch +** on the compiler command line. This is necessary if you are compiling +** on a recent machine (ex: RedHat 7.2) but you want your code to work +** on an older machine (ex: RedHat 6.0). If you compile on RedHat 7.2 +** without this option, LFS is enable. But LFS does not exist in the kernel +** in RedHat 6.0, so the code won't work. Hence, for maximum binary +** portability you should omit LFS. +** +** Similar is true for MacOS. LFS is only supported on MacOS 9 and later. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_DISABLE_LFS +# define _LARGE_FILE 1 +# ifndef _FILE_OFFSET_BITS +# define _FILE_OFFSET_BITS 64 +# endif +# define _LARGEFILE_SOURCE 1 +#endif + + +/************** Include sqliteLimit.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ***********/ +/************** Begin file sqliteLimit.h *************************************/ +/* +** 2007 May 7 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** +** This file defines various limits of what SQLite can process. +** +** @(#) $Id: sqliteLimit.h,v 1.5 2007/12/13 21:54:11 drh Exp $ +*/ + +/* +** The maximum length of a TEXT or BLOB in bytes. This also +** limits the size of a row in a table or index. +** +** The hard limit is the ability of a 32-bit signed integer +** to count the size: 2^31-1 or 2147483647. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH +# define SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH 1000000000 +#endif + +/* +** This is the maximum number of +** +** * Columns in a table +** * Columns in an index +** * Columns in a view +** * Terms in the SET clause of an UPDATE statement +** * Terms in the result set of a SELECT statement +** * Terms in the GROUP BY or ORDER BY clauses of a SELECT statement. +** * Terms in the VALUES clause of an INSERT statement +** +** The hard upper limit here is 32676. Most database people will +** tell you that in a well-normalized database, you usually should +** not have more than a dozen or so columns in any table. And if +** that is the case, there is no point in having more than a few +** dozen values in any of the other situations described above. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN +# define SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN 2000 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum length of a single SQL statement in bytes. +** The hard limit is 1 million. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH +# define SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH 1000000 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum depth of an expression tree. This is limited to +** some extent by SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH. But sometime you might +** want to place more severe limits on the complexity of an +** expression. A value of 0 (the default) means do not enforce +** any limitation on expression tree depth. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH +# define SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH 1000 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum number of terms in a compound SELECT statement. +** The code generator for compound SELECT statements does one +** level of recursion for each term. A stack overflow can result +** if the number of terms is too large. In practice, most SQL +** never has more than 3 or 4 terms. Use a value of 0 to disable +** any limit on the number of terms in a compount SELECT. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT +# define SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT 500 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum number of opcodes in a VDBE program. +** Not currently enforced. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP +# define SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP 25000 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum number of arguments to an SQL function. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG +# define SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG 100 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum number of in-memory pages to use for the main database +** table and for temporary tables. The SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_CACHE_SIZE 2000 +#endif +#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_TEMP_CACHE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_TEMP_CACHE_SIZE 500 +#endif + +/* +** The maximum number of attached databases. This must be at least 2 +** in order to support the main database file (0) and the file used to +** hold temporary tables (1). And it must be less than 32 because +** we use a bitmask of databases with a u32 in places (for example +** the Parse.cookieMask field). +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED +# define SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED 10 +#endif + + +/* +** The maximum value of a ?nnn wildcard that the parser will accept. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER +# define SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER 999 +#endif + +/* Maximum page size. The upper bound on this value is 32768. This a limit +** imposed by the necessity of storing the value in a 2-byte unsigned integer +** and the fact that the page size must be a power of 2. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE 32768 +#endif + + +/* +** The default size of a database page. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE 1024 +#endif +#if SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE +# undef SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE +#endif + +/* +** Ordinarily, if no value is explicitly provided, SQLite creates databases +** with page size SQLITE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE. However, based on certain +** device characteristics (sector-size and atomic write() support), +** SQLite may choose a larger value. This constant is the maximum value +** SQLite will choose on its own. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE 8192 +#endif +#if SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE>SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE +# undef SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE +# define SQLITE_MAX_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE +#endif + + +/* +** Maximum number of pages in one database file. +** +** This is really just the default value for the max_page_count pragma. +** This value can be lowered (or raised) at run-time using that the +** max_page_count macro. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT +# define SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT 1073741823 +#endif + +/* +** Maximum length (in bytes) of the pattern in a LIKE or GLOB +** operator. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH +# define SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH 50000 +#endif + +/************** End of sqliteLimit.h *****************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ + +/* +** For testing purposes, the various size limit constants are really +** variables that we can modify in the testfixture. +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_TEST + #undef SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH + #undef SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN + #undef SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH + #undef SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH + #undef SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT + #undef SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP + #undef SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG + #undef SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER + #undef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE + #undef SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT + #undef SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH + + #define SQLITE_MAX_LENGTH sqlite3MAX_LENGTH + #define SQLITE_MAX_COLUMN sqlite3MAX_COLUMN + #define SQLITE_MAX_SQL_LENGTH sqlite3MAX_SQL_LENGTH + #define SQLITE_MAX_EXPR_DEPTH sqlite3MAX_EXPR_DEPTH + #define SQLITE_MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT sqlite3MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT + #define SQLITE_MAX_VDBE_OP sqlite3MAX_VDBE_OP + #define SQLITE_MAX_FUNCTION_ARG sqlite3MAX_FUNCTION_ARG + #define SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER sqlite3MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER + #define SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_SIZE sqlite3MAX_PAGE_SIZE + #define SQLITE_MAX_PAGE_COUNT sqlite3MAX_PAGE_COUNT + #define SQLITE_MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH sqlite3MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH + + extern int sqlite3MAX_LENGTH; + extern int sqlite3MAX_COLUMN; + extern int sqlite3MAX_SQL_LENGTH; + extern int sqlite3MAX_EXPR_DEPTH; + extern int sqlite3MAX_COMPOUND_SELECT; + extern int sqlite3MAX_VDBE_OP; + extern int sqlite3MAX_FUNCTION_ARG; + extern int sqlite3MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER; + extern int sqlite3MAX_PAGE_SIZE; + extern int sqlite3MAX_PAGE_COUNT; + extern int sqlite3MAX_LIKE_PATTERN_LENGTH; +#endif + + +/* +** The SQLITE_THREADSAFE macro must be defined as either 0 or 1. +** Older versions of SQLite used an optional THREADSAFE macro. +** We support that for legacy +*/ +#if !defined(SQLITE_THREADSAFE) +#if defined(THREADSAFE) +# define SQLITE_THREADSAFE THREADSAFE +#else +# define SQLITE_THREADSAFE 1 +#endif +#endif + +/* +** We need to define _XOPEN_SOURCE as follows in order to enable +** recursive mutexes on most unix systems. But Mac OS X is different. +** The _XOPEN_SOURCE define causes problems for Mac OS X we are told, +** so it is omitted there. See ticket #2673. +** +** Later we learn that _XOPEN_SOURCE is poorly or incorrectly +** implemented on some systems. So we avoid defining it at all +** if it is already defined or if it is unneeded because we are +** not doing a threadsafe build. Ticket #2681. +** +** See also ticket #2741. +*/ +#if !defined(_XOPEN_SOURCE) && !defined(__DARWIN__) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE +# define _XOPEN_SOURCE 500 /* Needed to enable pthread recursive mutexes */ +#endif + +#if defined(SQLITE_TCL) || defined(TCLSH) +# include +#endif + +/* +** Many people are failing to set -DNDEBUG=1 when compiling SQLite. +** Setting NDEBUG makes the code smaller and run faster. So the following +** lines are added to automatically set NDEBUG unless the -DSQLITE_DEBUG=1 +** option is set. Thus NDEBUG becomes an opt-in rather than an opt-out +** feature. +*/ +#if !defined(NDEBUG) && !defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) +# define NDEBUG 1 +#endif + +/************** Include sqlite3.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ***************/ +/************** Begin file sqlite3.h *****************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 15 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** This header file defines the interface that the SQLite library +** presents to client programs. If a C-function, structure, datatype, +** or constant definition does not appear in this file, then it is +** not a published API of SQLite, is subject to change without +** notice, and should not be referenced by programs that use SQLite. +** +** Some of the definitions that are in this file are marked as +** "experimental". Experimental interfaces are normally new +** features recently added to SQLite. We do not anticipate changes +** to experimental interfaces but reserve to make minor changes if +** experience from use "in the wild" suggest such changes are prudent. +** +** The official C-language API documentation for SQLite is derived +** from comments in this file. This file is the authoritative source +** on how SQLite interfaces are suppose to operate. +** +** The name of this file under configuration management is "sqlite.h.in". +** The makefile makes some minor changes to this file (such as inserting +** the version number) and changes its name to "sqlite3.h" as +** part of the build process. +** +** @(#) $Id: sqlite.h.in,v 1.278 2007/12/13 21:54:11 drh Exp $ +*/ +#ifndef _SQLITE3_H_ +#define _SQLITE3_H_ +#include /* Needed for the definition of va_list */ + +/* +** Make sure we can call this stuff from C++. +*/ +#if 0 +extern "C" { +#endif + + +/* +** Add the ability to override 'extern' +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_EXTERN +# define SQLITE_EXTERN extern +#endif + +/* +** Make sure these symbols where not defined by some previous header +** file. +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_VERSION +# undef SQLITE_VERSION +#endif +#ifdef SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER +# undef SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER +#endif + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Compile-Time Library Version Numbers {F10010} +** +** {F10011} The #define in the sqlite3.h header file named +** SQLITE_VERSION resolves to a string literal that identifies +** the version of the SQLite library in the format "X.Y.Z", where +** X is the major version number, Y is the minor version number and Z +** is the release number. The X.Y.Z might be followed by "alpha" or "beta". +** {END} For example "3.1.1beta". +** +** The X value is always 3 in SQLite. The X value only changes when +** backwards compatibility is broken and we intend to never break +** backwards compatibility. The Y value only changes when +** there are major feature enhancements that are forwards compatible +** but not backwards compatible. The Z value is incremented with +** each release but resets back to 0 when Y is incremented. +** +** {F10014} The SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER #define resolves to an integer +** with the value (X*1000000 + Y*1000 + Z) where X, Y, and Z are as +** with SQLITE_VERSION. {END} For example, for version "3.1.1beta", +** SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER is set to 3001001. To detect if they are using +** version 3.1.1 or greater at compile time, programs may use the test +** (SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER>=3001001). +** +** See also: [sqlite3_libversion()] and [sqlite3_libversion_number()]. +*/ +#define SQLITE_VERSION "3.5.4" +#define SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER 3005004 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Run-Time Library Version Numbers {F10020} +** +** {F10021} The sqlite3_libversion_number() interface returns an integer +** equal to [SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER]. {END} The value returned +** by this routine should only be different from the header values +** if the application is compiled using an sqlite3.h header from a +** different version of SQLite than library. Cautious programmers might +** include a check in their application to verify that +** sqlite3_libversion_number() always returns the value +** [SQLITE_VERSION_NUMBER]. +** +** {F10022} The sqlite3_version[] string constant contains the text of the +** [SQLITE_VERSION] string. {F10023} The sqlite3_libversion() function returns +** a pointer to the sqlite3_version[] string constant. {END} The +** sqlite3_libversion() function +** is provided for DLL users who can only access functions and not +** constants within the DLL. +*/ +SQLITE_EXTERN const char sqlite3_version[]; +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_libversion(void); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_libversion_number(void); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Test To See If The Library Is Threadsafe {F10100} +** +** {F10101} The sqlite3_threadsafe() routine returns nonzero +** if SQLite was compiled with its mutexes enabled or zero if +** SQLite was compiled with mutexes disabled. {END} If this +** routine returns false, then it is not safe for simultaneously +** running threads to both invoke SQLite interfaces. +** +** Really all this routine does is return true if SQLite was +** compiled with the -DSQLITE_THREADSAFE=1 option and false if +** compiled with -DSQLITE_THREADSAFE=0. If SQLite uses an +** application-defined mutex subsystem, malloc subsystem, collating +** sequence, VFS, SQL function, progress callback, commit hook, +** extension, or other accessories and these add-ons are not +** threadsafe, then clearly the combination will not be threadsafe +** either. Hence, this routine never reports that the library +** is guaranteed to be threadsafe, only when it is guaranteed not +** to be. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_threadsafe(void); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Database Connection Handle {F12000} +** +** Each open SQLite database is represented by pointer to an instance of the +** opaque structure named "sqlite3". It is useful to think of an sqlite3 +** pointer as an object. The [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open16()], and +** [sqlite3_open_v2()] interfaces are its constructors +** and [sqlite3_close()] is its destructor. There are many other interfaces +** (such as [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], [sqlite3_create_function()], and +** [sqlite3_busy_timeout()] to name but three) that are methods on this +** object. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3 sqlite3; + + +/* +** CAPI3REF: 64-Bit Integer Types {F10200} +** +** Because there is no cross-platform way to specify such types +** SQLite includes typedefs for 64-bit signed and unsigned integers. +** {F10201} The sqlite_int64 and sqlite3_int64 types specify a +** 64-bit signed integer. {F10202} The sqlite_uint64 and +** sqlite3_uint64 types specify a 64-bit unsigned integer. {END} +** +** The sqlite3_int64 and sqlite3_uint64 are the preferred type +** definitions. The sqlite_int64 and sqlite_uint64 types are +** supported for backwards compatibility only. +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_INT64_TYPE + typedef SQLITE_INT64_TYPE sqlite_int64; + typedef unsigned SQLITE_INT64_TYPE sqlite_uint64; +#elif defined(_MSC_VER) || defined(__BORLANDC__) + typedef __int64 sqlite_int64; + typedef unsigned __int64 sqlite_uint64; +#else + typedef long long int sqlite_int64; + typedef unsigned long long int sqlite_uint64; +#endif +typedef sqlite_int64 sqlite3_int64; +typedef sqlite_uint64 sqlite3_uint64; + +/* +** If compiling for a processor that lacks floating point support, +** substitute integer for floating-point +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT +# define double sqlite3_int64 +#endif + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Closing A Database Connection {F12010} +** +** {F12011} The sqlite3_close() interfaces destroys an [sqlite3] object +** allocated by a prior call to [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open16()], or +** [sqlite3_open_v2()]. {F12012} Sqlite3_close() releases all +** memory used by the connection and closes all open files. {END}. +** +** {F12013} If the database connection contains +** [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statements] that have not been finalized +** by [sqlite3_finalize()], then sqlite3_close() returns SQLITE_BUSY +** and leaves the connection open. {F12014} Giving sqlite3_close() +** a NULL pointer is a harmless no-op. {END} +** +** {U12015} Passing this routine a database connection that has already been +** closed results in undefined behavior. {U12016} If other interfaces that +** reference the same database connection are pending (either in the +** same thread or in different threads) when this routine is called, +** then the behavior is undefined and is almost certainly undesirable. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_close(sqlite3 *); + +/* +** The type for a callback function. +** This is legacy and deprecated. It is included for historical +** compatibility and is not documented. +*/ +typedef int (*sqlite3_callback)(void*,int,char**, char**); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: One-Step Query Execution Interface {F12100} +** +** {F12101} The sqlite3_exec() interface evaluates zero or more +** UTF-8 encoded, semicolon-separated SQL statements in the zero-terminated +** string of its second argument. {F12102} The SQL +** statements are evaluated in the context of the database connection +** specified by in the first argument. +** {F12103} SQL statements are prepared one by one using +** [sqlite3_prepare()] or the equivalent, evaluated +** using one or more calls to [sqlite3_step()], then destroyed +** using [sqlite3_finalize()]. {F12104} The return value of +** sqlite3_exec() is SQLITE_OK if all SQL statement run +** successfully. +** +** {F12105} If one or more of the SQL statements handed to +** sqlite3_exec() are queries, then +** the callback function specified by the 3rd parameter is +** invoked once for each row of the query result. {F12106} +** If the callback returns a non-zero value then the query +** is aborted, all subsequent SQL statements +** are skipped and the sqlite3_exec() function returns the [SQLITE_ABORT]. +** +** {F12107} The 4th parameter to sqlite3_exec() is an arbitrary pointer +** that is passed through to the callback function as its first parameter. +** +** {F12108} The 2nd parameter to the callback function is the number of +** columns in the query result. {F12109} The 3rd parameter to the callback +** is an array of pointers to strings holding the values for each column +** as extracted using [sqlite3_column_text()]. NULL values in the result +** set result in a NULL pointer. All other value are in their UTF-8 +** string representation. {F12117} +** The 4th parameter to the callback is an array of strings +** obtained using [sqlite3_column_name()] and holding +** the names of each column, also in UTF-8. +** +** {F12110} The callback function may be NULL, even for queries. A NULL +** callback is not an error. It just means that no callback +** will be invoked. +** +** {F12112} If an error occurs while parsing or evaluating the SQL +** then an appropriate error message is written into memory obtained +** from [sqlite3_malloc()] and *errmsg is made to point to that message +** assuming errmsg is not NULL. +** {U12113} The calling function is responsible for freeing the memory +** using [sqlite3_free()]. +** {F12116} If [sqlite3_malloc()] fails while attempting to generate +** the error message, *errmsg is set to NULL. +** {F12114} If errmsg is NULL then no attempt is made to generate an +** error message. Is the return code SQLITE_NOMEM or the original +** error code? What happens if there are multiple errors? +** Do we get code for the first error, or is the choice of reported +** error arbitrary? +** +** {F12115} The return value is is SQLITE_OK if there are no errors and +** some other [SQLITE_OK | return code] if there is an error. +** The particular return value depends on the type of error. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_exec( + sqlite3*, /* An open database */ + const char *sql, /* SQL to be evaluted */ + int (*callback)(void*,int,char**,char**), /* Callback function */ + void *, /* 1st argument to callback */ + char **errmsg /* Error msg written here */ +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Result Codes {F10210} +** KEYWORDS: SQLITE_OK +** +** Many SQLite functions return an integer result code from the set shown +** above in order to indicates success or failure. +** +** {F10211} The result codes shown here are the only ones returned +** by SQLite in its default configuration. {F10212} However, the +** [sqlite3_extended_result_codes()] API can be used to set a database +** connectoin to return more detailed result codes. {END} +** +** See also: [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended result codes] +** +*/ +#define SQLITE_OK 0 /* Successful result */ +/* beginning-of-error-codes */ +#define SQLITE_ERROR 1 /* SQL error or missing database */ +#define SQLITE_INTERNAL 2 /* Internal logic error in SQLite */ +#define SQLITE_PERM 3 /* Access permission denied */ +#define SQLITE_ABORT 4 /* Callback routine requested an abort */ +#define SQLITE_BUSY 5 /* The database file is locked */ +#define SQLITE_LOCKED 6 /* A table in the database is locked */ +#define SQLITE_NOMEM 7 /* A malloc() failed */ +#define SQLITE_READONLY 8 /* Attempt to write a readonly database */ +#define SQLITE_INTERRUPT 9 /* Operation terminated by sqlite3_interrupt()*/ +#define SQLITE_IOERR 10 /* Some kind of disk I/O error occurred */ +#define SQLITE_CORRUPT 11 /* The database disk image is malformed */ +#define SQLITE_NOTFOUND 12 /* NOT USED. Table or record not found */ +#define SQLITE_FULL 13 /* Insertion failed because database is full */ +#define SQLITE_CANTOPEN 14 /* Unable to open the database file */ +#define SQLITE_PROTOCOL 15 /* NOT USED. Database lock protocol error */ +#define SQLITE_EMPTY 16 /* Database is empty */ +#define SQLITE_SCHEMA 17 /* The database schema changed */ +#define SQLITE_TOOBIG 18 /* String or BLOB exceeds size limit */ +#define SQLITE_CONSTRAINT 19 /* Abort due to constraint violation */ +#define SQLITE_MISMATCH 20 /* Data type mismatch */ +#define SQLITE_MISUSE 21 /* Library used incorrectly */ +#define SQLITE_NOLFS 22 /* Uses OS features not supported on host */ +#define SQLITE_AUTH 23 /* Authorization denied */ +#define SQLITE_FORMAT 24 /* Auxiliary database format error */ +#define SQLITE_RANGE 25 /* 2nd parameter to sqlite3_bind out of range */ +#define SQLITE_NOTADB 26 /* File opened that is not a database file */ +#define SQLITE_ROW 100 /* sqlite3_step() has another row ready */ +#define SQLITE_DONE 101 /* sqlite3_step() has finished executing */ +/* end-of-error-codes */ + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Extended Result Codes {F10220} +** +** In its default configuration, SQLite API routines return one of 26 integer +** [SQLITE_OK | result codes]. However, experience has shown that +** many of these result codes are too course-grained. They do not provide as +** much information about problems as programmers might like. In an effort to +** address this, newer versions of SQLite (version 3.3.8 and later) include +** support for additional result codes that provide more detailed information +** about errors. {F10221} The extended result codes are enabled or disabled +** for each database connection using the [sqlite3_extended_result_codes()] +** API. {END} +** +** Some of the available extended result codes are listed above. +** We expect the number of extended result codes will be expand +** over time. {U10422} Software that uses extended result codes should expect +** to see new result codes in future releases of SQLite. {END} +** +** {F10223} The symbolic name for an extended result code always contains +** a related primary result code as a prefix. {F10224} Primary result +** codes contain a single "_" character. {F10225} Extended result codes +** contain two or more "_" characters. {F10226} The numeric value of an +** extended result code can be converted to its +** corresponding primary result code by masking off the lower 8 bytes. {END} +** +** The SQLITE_OK result code will never be extended. It will always +** be exactly zero. +*/ +#define SQLITE_IOERR_READ (SQLITE_IOERR | (1<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_SHORT_READ (SQLITE_IOERR | (2<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_WRITE (SQLITE_IOERR | (3<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_FSYNC (SQLITE_IOERR | (4<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_DIR_FSYNC (SQLITE_IOERR | (5<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_TRUNCATE (SQLITE_IOERR | (6<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_FSTAT (SQLITE_IOERR | (7<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_UNLOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (8<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_RDLOCK (SQLITE_IOERR | (9<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_DELETE (SQLITE_IOERR | (10<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED (SQLITE_IOERR | (11<<8)) +#define SQLITE_IOERR_NOMEM (SQLITE_IOERR | (12<<8)) + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Flags For File Open Operations {F10230} +** +** {F10231} Some combination of the these bit values are used as the +** third argument to the [sqlite3_open_v2()] interface and +** as fourth argument to the xOpen method of the +** [sqlite3_vfs] object. +*/ +#define SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY 0x00000001 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE 0x00000002 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE 0x00000004 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE 0x00000008 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE 0x00000010 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB 0x00000100 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB 0x00000200 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_TRANSIENT_DB 0x00000400 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL 0x00000800 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_JOURNAL 0x00001000 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_SUBJOURNAL 0x00002000 +#define SQLITE_OPEN_MASTER_JOURNAL 0x00004000 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Device Characteristics {F10240} +** +** {F10241} The xDeviceCapabilities method of the [sqlite3_io_methods] +** object returns an integer which is a vector of the these +** bit values expressing I/O characteristics of the mass storage +** device that holds the file that the [sqlite3_io_methods] +** refers to. {END} +** +** {F10242} The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC property means that all writes of +** any size are atomic. {F10243} The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMICnnn values +** mean that writes of blocks that are nnn bytes in size and +** are aligned to an address which is an integer multiple of +** nnn are atomic. {F10244} The SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND value means +** that when data is appended to a file, the data is appended +** first then the size of the file is extended, never the other +** way around. {F10245} The SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL property means that +** information is written to disk in the same order as calls +** to xWrite(). +*/ +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC 0x00000001 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512 0x00000002 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC1K 0x00000004 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC2K 0x00000008 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC4K 0x00000010 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC8K 0x00000020 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC16K 0x00000040 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC32K 0x00000080 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC64K 0x00000100 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND 0x00000200 +#define SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL 0x00000400 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: File Locking Levels {F10250} +** +** {F10251} SQLite uses one of the following integer values as the second +** argument to calls it makes to the xLock() and xUnlock() methods +** of an [sqlite3_io_methods] object. {END} +*/ +#define SQLITE_LOCK_NONE 0 +#define SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED 1 +#define SQLITE_LOCK_RESERVED 2 +#define SQLITE_LOCK_PENDING 3 +#define SQLITE_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE 4 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Synchronization Type Flags {F10260} +** +** {F10261} When SQLite invokes the xSync() method of an +** [sqlite3_io_methods] object it uses a combination of the +** these integer values as the second argument. +** +** {F10262} When the SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY flag is used, it means that the +** sync operation only needs to flush data to mass storage. Inode +** information need not be flushed. {F10263} The SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL means +** to use normal fsync() semantics. {F10264} The SQLITE_SYNC_FULL flag means +** to use Mac OS-X style fullsync instead of fsync(). +*/ +#define SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL 0x00002 +#define SQLITE_SYNC_FULL 0x00003 +#define SQLITE_SYNC_DATAONLY 0x00010 + + +/* +** CAPI3REF: OS Interface Open File Handle {F11110} +** +** An [sqlite3_file] object represents an open file in the OS +** interface layer. Individual OS interface implementations will +** want to subclass this object by appending additional fields +** for their own use. The pMethods entry is a pointer to an +** [sqlite3_io_methods] object that defines methods for performing +** I/O operations on the open file. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_file sqlite3_file; +struct sqlite3_file { + const struct sqlite3_io_methods *pMethods; /* Methods for an open file */ +}; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: OS Interface File Virtual Methods Object {F11120} +** +** Every file opened by the [sqlite3_vfs] xOpen method contains a pointer to +** an instance of the this object. This object defines the +** methods used to perform various operations against the open file. +** +** The flags argument to xSync may be one of [SQLITE_SYNC_NORMAL] or +** [SQLITE_SYNC_FULL]. The first choice is the normal fsync(). +* The second choice is an +** OS-X style fullsync. The SQLITE_SYNC_DATA flag may be ORed in to +** indicate that only the data of the file and not its inode needs to be +** synced. +** +** The integer values to xLock() and xUnlock() are one of +**
    +**
  • [SQLITE_LOCK_NONE], +**
  • [SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED], +**
  • [SQLITE_LOCK_RESERVED], +**
  • [SQLITE_LOCK_PENDING], or +**
  • [SQLITE_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE]. +**
+** xLock() increases the lock. xUnlock() decreases the lock. +** The xCheckReservedLock() method looks +** to see if any database connection, either in this +** process or in some other process, is holding an RESERVED, +** PENDING, or EXCLUSIVE lock on the file. It returns true +** if such a lock exists and false if not. +** +** The xFileControl() method is a generic interface that allows custom +** VFS implementations to directly control an open file using the +** [sqlite3_file_control()] interface. The second "op" argument +** is an integer opcode. The third +** argument is a generic pointer which is intended to be a pointer +** to a structure that may contain arguments or space in which to +** write return values. Potential uses for xFileControl() might be +** functions to enable blocking locks with timeouts, to change the +** locking strategy (for example to use dot-file locks), to inquire +** about the status of a lock, or to break stale locks. The SQLite +** core reserves opcodes less than 100 for its own use. +** A [SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE | list of opcodes] less than 100 is available. +** Applications that define a custom xFileControl method should use opcodes +** greater than 100 to avoid conflicts. +** +** The xSectorSize() method returns the sector size of the +** device that underlies the file. The sector size is the +** minimum write that can be performed without disturbing +** other bytes in the file. The xDeviceCharacteristics() +** method returns a bit vector describing behaviors of the +** underlying device: +** +**
    +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC512] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC1K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC2K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC4K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC8K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC16K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC32K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC64K] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND] +**
  • [SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL] +**
+** +** The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMIC property means that all writes of +** any size are atomic. The SQLITE_IOCAP_ATOMICnnn values +** mean that writes of blocks that are nnn bytes in size and +** are aligned to an address which is an integer multiple of +** nnn are atomic. The SQLITE_IOCAP_SAFE_APPEND value means +** that when data is appended to a file, the data is appended +** first then the size of the file is extended, never the other +** way around. The SQLITE_IOCAP_SEQUENTIAL property means that +** information is written to disk in the same order as calls +** to xWrite(). +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_io_methods sqlite3_io_methods; +struct sqlite3_io_methods { + int iVersion; + int (*xClose)(sqlite3_file*); + int (*xRead)(sqlite3_file*, void*, int iAmt, sqlite3_int64 iOfst); + int (*xWrite)(sqlite3_file*, const void*, int iAmt, sqlite3_int64 iOfst); + int (*xTruncate)(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 size); + int (*xSync)(sqlite3_file*, int flags); + int (*xFileSize)(sqlite3_file*, sqlite3_int64 *pSize); + int (*xLock)(sqlite3_file*, int); + int (*xUnlock)(sqlite3_file*, int); + int (*xCheckReservedLock)(sqlite3_file*); + int (*xFileControl)(sqlite3_file*, int op, void *pArg); + int (*xSectorSize)(sqlite3_file*); + int (*xDeviceCharacteristics)(sqlite3_file*); + /* Additional methods may be added in future releases */ +}; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Standard File Control Opcodes {F11310} +** +** These integer constants are opcodes for the xFileControl method +** of the [sqlite3_io_methods] object and to the [sqlite3_file_control()] +** interface. +** +** {F11311} The [SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE] opcode is used for debugging. This +** opcode cases the xFileControl method to write the current state of +** the lock (one of [SQLITE_LOCK_NONE], [SQLITE_LOCK_SHARED], +** [SQLITE_LOCK_RESERVED], [SQLITE_LOCK_PENDING], or [SQLITE_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE]) +** into an integer that the pArg argument points to. {F11312} This capability +** is used during testing and only needs to be supported when SQLITE_TEST +** is defined. +*/ +#define SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE 1 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Mutex Handle {F17110} +** +** The mutex module within SQLite defines [sqlite3_mutex] to be an +** abstract type for a mutex object. {F17111} The SQLite core never looks +** at the internal representation of an [sqlite3_mutex]. {END} It only +** deals with pointers to the [sqlite3_mutex] object. +** +** Mutexes are created using [sqlite3_mutex_alloc()]. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_mutex sqlite3_mutex; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: OS Interface Object {F11140} +** +** An instance of this object defines the interface between the +** SQLite core and the underlying operating system. The "vfs" +** in the name of the object stands for "virtual file system". +** +** The iVersion field is initially 1 but may be larger for future +** versions of SQLite. Additional fields may be appended to this +** object when the iVersion value is increased. +** +** The szOsFile field is the size of the subclassed [sqlite3_file] +** structure used by this VFS. mxPathname is the maximum length of +** a pathname in this VFS. +** +** Registered vfs modules are kept on a linked list formed by +** the pNext pointer. The [sqlite3_vfs_register()] +** and [sqlite3_vfs_unregister()] interfaces manage this list +** in a thread-safe way. The [sqlite3_vfs_find()] interface +** searches the list. +** +** The pNext field is the only fields in the sqlite3_vfs +** structure that SQLite will ever modify. SQLite will only access +** or modify this field while holding a particular static mutex. +** The application should never modify anything within the sqlite3_vfs +** object once the object has been registered. +** +** The zName field holds the name of the VFS module. The name must +** be unique across all VFS modules. +** +** {F11141} SQLite will guarantee that the zFilename string passed to +** xOpen() is a full pathname as generated by xFullPathname() and +** that the string will be valid and unchanged until xClose() is +** called. {END} So the [sqlite3_file] can store a pointer to the +** filename if it needs to remember the filename for some reason. +** +** {F11142} The flags argument to xOpen() includes all bits set in +** the flags argument to [sqlite3_open_v2()]. Or if [sqlite3_open()] +** or [sqlite3_open16()] is used, then flags includes at least +** [SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE] | [SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE]. {END} +** If xOpen() opens a file read-only then it sets *pOutFlags to +** include [SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY]. Other bits in *pOutFlags may be +** set. +** +** {F11143} SQLite will also add one of the following flags to the xOpen() +** call, depending on the object being opened: +** +**
    +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_DB] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_MAIN_JOURNAL] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_DB] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_TEMP_JOURNAL] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_TRANSIENT_DB] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_SUBJOURNAL] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_MASTER_JOURNAL] +**
{END} +** +** The file I/O implementation can use the object type flags to +** changes the way it deals with files. For example, an application +** that does not care about crash recovery or rollback, might make +** the open of a journal file a no-op. Writes to this journal are +** also a no-op. Any attempt to read the journal return SQLITE_IOERR. +** Or the implementation might recognize the a database file will +** be doing page-aligned sector reads and writes in a random order +** and set up its I/O subsystem accordingly. +** +** {F11144} SQLite might also add one of the following flags to the xOpen +** method: +** +**
    +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE] +**
  • [SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE] +**
+** +** {F11145} The [SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE] flag means the file should be +** deleted when it is closed. {F11146} The [SQLITE_OPEN_DELETEONCLOSE] +** will be set for TEMP databases, journals and for subjournals. +** {F11147} The [SQLITE_OPEN_EXCLUSIVE] flag means the file should be opened +** for exclusive access. This flag is set for all files except +** for the main database file. {END} +** +** {F11148} At least szOsFile bytes of memory is allocated by SQLite +** to hold the [sqlite3_file] structure passed as the third +** argument to xOpen. {END} The xOpen method does not have to +** allocate the structure; it should just fill it in. +** +** {F11149} The flags argument to xAccess() may be [SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS] +** to test for the existance of a file, +** or [SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE] to test to see +** if a file is readable and writable, or [SQLITE_ACCESS_READ] +** to test to see if a file is at least readable. {END} The file can be a +** directory. +** +** {F11150} SQLite will always allocate at least mxPathname+1 byte for +** the output buffers for xGetTempname and xFullPathname. {F11151} The exact +** size of the output buffer is also passed as a parameter to both +** methods. {END} If the output buffer is not large enough, SQLITE_CANTOPEN +** should be returned. As this is handled as a fatal error by SQLite, +** vfs implementations should endeavor to prevent this by setting +** mxPathname to a sufficiently large value. +** +** The xRandomness(), xSleep(), and xCurrentTime() interfaces +** are not strictly a part of the filesystem, but they are +** included in the VFS structure for completeness. +** The xRandomness() function attempts to return nBytes bytes +** of good-quality randomness into zOut. The return value is +** the actual number of bytes of randomness obtained. The +** xSleep() method cause the calling thread to sleep for at +** least the number of microseconds given. The xCurrentTime() +** method returns a Julian Day Number for the current date and +** time. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_vfs sqlite3_vfs; +struct sqlite3_vfs { + int iVersion; /* Structure version number */ + int szOsFile; /* Size of subclassed sqlite3_file */ + int mxPathname; /* Maximum file pathname length */ + sqlite3_vfs *pNext; /* Next registered VFS */ + const char *zName; /* Name of this virtual file system */ + void *pAppData; /* Pointer to application-specific data */ + int (*xOpen)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, sqlite3_file*, + int flags, int *pOutFlags); + int (*xDelete)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int syncDir); + int (*xAccess)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int flags); + int (*xGetTempname)(sqlite3_vfs*, int nOut, char *zOut); + int (*xFullPathname)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zName, int nOut, char *zOut); + void *(*xDlOpen)(sqlite3_vfs*, const char *zFilename); + void (*xDlError)(sqlite3_vfs*, int nByte, char *zErrMsg); + void *(*xDlSym)(sqlite3_vfs*,void*, const char *zSymbol); + void (*xDlClose)(sqlite3_vfs*, void*); + int (*xRandomness)(sqlite3_vfs*, int nByte, char *zOut); + int (*xSleep)(sqlite3_vfs*, int microseconds); + int (*xCurrentTime)(sqlite3_vfs*, double*); + /* New fields may be appended in figure versions. The iVersion + ** value will increment whenever this happens. */ +}; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Flags for the xAccess VFS method {F11190} +** +** {F11191} These integer constants can be used as the third parameter to +** the xAccess method of an [sqlite3_vfs] object. {END} They determine +** the kind of what kind of permissions the xAccess method is +** looking for. {F11192} With SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS, the xAccess method +** simply checks to see if the file exists. {F11193} With +** SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE, the xAccess method checks to see +** if the file is both readable and writable. {F11194} With +** SQLITE_ACCESS_READ the xAccess method +** checks to see if the file is readable. +*/ +#define SQLITE_ACCESS_EXISTS 0 +#define SQLITE_ACCESS_READWRITE 1 +#define SQLITE_ACCESS_READ 2 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable Extended Result Codes {F12200} +** +** {F12201} The sqlite3_extended_result_codes() routine enables or disables the +** [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended result codes] feature on a database +** connection if its 2nd parameter is +** non-zero or zero, respectively. {F12202} +** By default, SQLite API routines return one of only 26 integer +** [SQLITE_OK | result codes]. {F12203} When extended result codes +** are enabled by this routine, the repetoire of result codes can be +** much larger and can (hopefully) provide more detailed information +** about the cause of an error. +** +** {F12204} The second argument is a boolean value that turns extended result +** codes on and off. {F12205} Extended result codes are off by default for +** backwards compatibility with older versions of SQLite. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_extended_result_codes(sqlite3*, int onoff); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Last Insert Rowid {F12220} +** +** {F12221} Each entry in an SQLite table has a unique 64-bit signed +** integer key called the "rowid". {F12222} The rowid is always available +** as an undeclared column named ROWID, OID, or _ROWID_ as long as those +** names are not also used by explicitly declared columns. {F12223} If +** the table has a column of type INTEGER PRIMARY KEY then that column +** is another an alias for the rowid. +** +** {F12224} This routine returns the rowid of the most recent +** successful INSERT into the database from the database connection +** shown in the first argument. {F12225} If no successful inserts +** have ever occurred on this database connection, zero is returned. +** +** {F12226} If an INSERT occurs within a trigger, then the rowid of the +** inserted row is returned by this routine as long as the trigger +** is running. {F12227} But once the trigger terminates, the value returned +** by this routine reverts to the last value inserted before the +** trigger fired. +** +** {F12228} An INSERT that fails due to a constraint violation is not a +** successful insert and does not change the value returned by this +** routine. {F12229} Thus INSERT OR FAIL, INSERT OR IGNORE, INSERT OR ROLLBACK, +** and INSERT OR ABORT make no changes to the return value of this +** routine when their insertion fails. {F12231} When INSERT OR REPLACE +** encounters a constraint violation, it does not fail. The +** INSERT continues to completion after deleting rows that caused +** the constraint problem so INSERT OR REPLACE will always change +** the return value of this interface. +** +** {UF12232} If another thread does a new insert on the same database connection +** while this routine is running and thus changes the last insert rowid, +** then the return value of this routine is undefined. +*/ +SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_last_insert_rowid(sqlite3*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Count The Number Of Rows Modified {F12240} +** +** {F12241} This function returns the number of database rows that were changed +** or inserted or deleted by the most recently completed SQL statement +** on the connection specified by the first parameter. {F12242} Only +** changes that are directly specified by the INSERT, UPDATE, or +** DELETE statement are counted. Auxiliary changes caused by +** triggers are not counted. {F12243} Use the [sqlite3_total_changes()] function +** to find the total number of changes including changes caused by triggers. +** +** {F12244} Within the body of a trigger, the sqlite3_changes() interface +** can be called to find the number of +** changes in the most recently completed INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE +** statement within the body of the same trigger. +** +** {F12245} All changes are counted, even if they are later undone by a +** ROLLBACK or ABORT. {F12246} Except, changes associated with creating and +** dropping tables are not counted. +** +** {F12247} If a callback invokes [sqlite3_exec()] or [sqlite3_step()] +** recursively, then the changes in the inner, recursive call are +** counted together with the changes in the outer call. +** +** {F12248} SQLite implements the command "DELETE FROM table" without +** a WHERE clause by dropping and recreating the table. (This is much +** faster than going through and deleting individual elements from the +** table.) Because of this optimization, the change count for +** "DELETE FROM table" will be zero regardless of the number of elements +** that were originally in the table. {F12251} To get an accurate count +** of the number of rows deleted, use +** "DELETE FROM table WHERE 1" instead. +** +** {UF12252} If another thread makes changes on the same database connection +** while this routine is running then the return value of this routine +** is undefined. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_changes(sqlite3*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Total Number Of Rows Modified {F12260} +*** +** {F12261} This function returns the number of database rows that have been +** modified by INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE statements since the database handle +** was opened. {F12262} The count includes UPDATE, INSERT and DELETE +** statements executed as part of trigger programs. {F12263} All changes +** are counted as soon as the statement that makes them is completed +** (when the statement handle is passed to [sqlite3_reset()] or +** [sqlite3_finalize()]). {END} +** +** See also the [sqlite3_change()] interface. +** +** {F12265} SQLite implements the command "DELETE FROM table" without +** a WHERE clause by dropping and recreating the table. (This is much +** faster than going +** through and deleting individual elements form the table.) Because of +** this optimization, the change count for "DELETE FROM table" will be +** zero regardless of the number of elements that were originally in the +** table. To get an accurate count of the number of rows deleted, use +** "DELETE FROM table WHERE 1" instead. +** +** {U12264} If another thread makes changes on the same database connection +** while this routine is running then the return value of this routine +** is undefined. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_total_changes(sqlite3*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Interrupt A Long-Running Query {F12270} +** +** {F12271} This function causes any pending database operation to abort and +** return at its earliest opportunity. {END} This routine is typically +** called in response to a user action such as pressing "Cancel" +** or Ctrl-C where the user wants a long query operation to halt +** immediately. +** +** {F12272} It is safe to call this routine from a thread different from the +** thread that is currently running the database operation. {U12273} But it +** is not safe to call this routine with a database connection that +** is closed or might close before sqlite3_interrupt() returns. +** +** If an SQL is very nearly finished at the time when sqlite3_interrupt() +** is called, then it might not have an opportunity to be interrupted. +** It might continue to completion. +** {F12274} The SQL operation that is interrupted will return +** [SQLITE_INTERRUPT]. {F12275} If the interrupted SQL operation is an +** INSERT, UPDATE, or DELETE that is inside an explicit transaction, +** then the entire transaction will be rolled back automatically. +** {F12276} A call to sqlite3_interrupt() has no effect on SQL statements +** that are started after sqlite3_interrupt() returns. +*/ +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_interrupt(sqlite3*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Determine If An SQL Statement Is Complete {F10510} +** +** These routines are useful for command-line input to determine if the +** currently entered text seems to form complete a SQL statement or +** if additional input is needed before sending the text into +** SQLite for parsing. These routines return true if the input string +** appears to be a complete SQL statement. A statement is judged to be +** complete if it ends with a semicolon and is not a fragment of a +** CREATE TRIGGER statement. These routines do not parse the SQL and +** so will not detect syntactically incorrect SQL. +** +** {F10511} These functions return true if the given input string +** ends with a semicolon optionally followed by whitespace or +** comments. {F10512} For sqlite3_complete(), +** the parameter must be a zero-terminated UTF-8 string. {F10513} For +** sqlite3_complete16(), a zero-terminated machine byte order UTF-16 string +** is required. {F10514} These routines return false if the terminal +** semicolon is within a comment, a string literal or a quoted identifier +** (in other words if the final semicolon is not really a separate token +** but part of a larger token) or if the final semicolon is +** in between the BEGIN and END keywords of a CREATE TRIGGER statement. +** {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_complete(const char *sql); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_complete16(const void *sql); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Register A Callback To Handle SQLITE_BUSY Errors {F12310} +** +** {F12311} This routine identifies a callback function that might be +** invoked whenever an attempt is made to open a database table +** that another thread or process has locked. +** {F12312} If the busy callback is NULL, then [SQLITE_BUSY] +** or [SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED] +** is returned immediately upon encountering the lock. +** {F12313} If the busy callback is not NULL, then the +** callback will be invoked with two arguments. {F12314} The +** first argument to the handler is a copy of the void* pointer which +** is the third argument to this routine. {F12315} The second argument to +** the handler is the number of times that the busy handler has +** been invoked for this locking event. {F12316} If the +** busy callback returns 0, then no additional attempts are made to +** access the database and [SQLITE_BUSY] or [SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED] is returned. +** {F12317} If the callback returns non-zero, then another attempt +** is made to open the database for reading and the cycle repeats. +** +** The presence of a busy handler does not guarantee that +** it will be invoked when there is lock contention. {F12319} +** If SQLite determines that invoking the busy handler could result in +** a deadlock, it will go ahead and return [SQLITE_BUSY] or +** [SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED] instead of invoking the +** busy handler. {END} +** Consider a scenario where one process is holding a read lock that +** it is trying to promote to a reserved lock and +** a second process is holding a reserved lock that it is trying +** to promote to an exclusive lock. The first process cannot proceed +** because it is blocked by the second and the second process cannot +** proceed because it is blocked by the first. If both processes +** invoke the busy handlers, neither will make any progress. Therefore, +** SQLite returns [SQLITE_BUSY] for the first process, hoping that this +** will induce the first process to release its read lock and allow +** the second process to proceed. +** +** {F12321} The default busy callback is NULL. {END} +** +** {F12322} The [SQLITE_BUSY] error is converted to [SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED] +** when SQLite is in the middle of a large transaction where all the +** changes will not fit into the in-memory cache. {F12323} SQLite will +** already hold a RESERVED lock on the database file, but it needs +** to promote this lock to EXCLUSIVE so that it can spill cache +** pages into the database file without harm to concurrent +** readers. {F12324} If it is unable to promote the lock, then the in-memory +** cache will be left in an inconsistent state and so the error +** code is promoted from the relatively benign [SQLITE_BUSY] to +** the more severe [SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED]. {F12325} This error code promotion +** forces an automatic rollback of the changes. {END} See the +** +** CorruptionFollowingBusyError wiki page for a discussion of why +** this is important. +** +** {F12326} Sqlite is re-entrant, so the busy handler may start a new +** query. {END} (It is not clear why anyone would every want to do this, +** but it is allowed, in theory.) {U12327} But the busy handler may not +** close the database. Closing the database from a busy handler will delete +** data structures out from under the executing query and will +** probably result in a segmentation fault or other runtime error. {END} +** +** {F12328} There can only be a single busy handler defined for each database +** connection. Setting a new busy handler clears any previous one. +** {F12329} Note that calling [sqlite3_busy_timeout()] will also set or clear +** the busy handler. +** +** {F12331} When operating in [sqlite3_enable_shared_cache | shared cache mode], +** only a single busy handler can be defined for each database file. +** So if two database connections share a single cache, then changing +** the busy handler on one connection will also change the busy +** handler in the other connection. {F12332} The busy handler is invoked +** in the thread that was running when the lock contention occurs. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_busy_handler(sqlite3*, int(*)(void*,int), void*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Set A Busy Timeout {F12340} +** +** {F12341} This routine sets a [sqlite3_busy_handler | busy handler] +** that sleeps for a while when a +** table is locked. {F12342} The handler will sleep multiple times until +** at least "ms" milliseconds of sleeping have been done. {F12343} After +** "ms" milliseconds of sleeping, the handler returns 0 which +** causes [sqlite3_step()] to return [SQLITE_BUSY] or [SQLITE_IOERR_BLOCKED]. +** +** {F12344} Calling this routine with an argument less than or equal to zero +** turns off all busy handlers. +** +** {F12345} There can only be a single busy handler for a particular database +** connection. If another busy handler was defined +** (using [sqlite3_busy_handler()]) prior to calling +** this routine, that other busy handler is cleared. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_busy_timeout(sqlite3*, int ms); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Convenience Routines For Running Queries {F12370} +** +** This next routine is a convenience wrapper around [sqlite3_exec()]. +** {F12371} Instead of invoking a user-supplied callback for each row of the +** result, this routine remembers each row of the result in memory +** obtained from [sqlite3_malloc()], then returns all of the result after the +** query has finished. {F12372} +** +** As an example, suppose the query result where this table: +** +**
+**        Name        | Age
+**        -----------------------
+**        Alice       | 43
+**        Bob         | 28
+**        Cindy       | 21
+** 
+** +** If the 3rd argument were &azResult then after the function returns +** azResult will contain the following data: +** +**
+**        azResult[0] = "Name";
+**        azResult[1] = "Age";
+**        azResult[2] = "Alice";
+**        azResult[3] = "43";
+**        azResult[4] = "Bob";
+**        azResult[5] = "28";
+**        azResult[6] = "Cindy";
+**        azResult[7] = "21";
+** 
+** +** Notice that there is an extra row of data containing the column +** headers. But the *nrow return value is still 3. *ncolumn is +** set to 2. In general, the number of values inserted into azResult +** will be ((*nrow) + 1)*(*ncolumn). +** +** {U12374} After the calling function has finished using the result, it should +** pass the result data pointer to sqlite3_free_table() in order to +** release the memory that was malloc-ed. Because of the way the +** [sqlite3_malloc()] happens, the calling function must not try to call +** [sqlite3_free()] directly. Only [sqlite3_free_table()] is able to release +** the memory properly and safely. {END} +** +** {F12373} The return value of this routine is the same as +** from [sqlite3_exec()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_get_table( + sqlite3*, /* An open database */ + const char *sql, /* SQL to be executed */ + char ***resultp, /* Result written to a char *[] that this points to */ + int *nrow, /* Number of result rows written here */ + int *ncolumn, /* Number of result columns written here */ + char **errmsg /* Error msg written here */ +); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_free_table(char **result); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Formatted String Printing Functions {F17400} +** +** These routines are workalikes of the "printf()" family of functions +** from the standard C library. +** +** {F17401} The sqlite3_mprintf() and sqlite3_vmprintf() routines write their +** results into memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc()]. +** {U17402} The strings returned by these two routines should be +** released by [sqlite3_free()]. {F17403} Both routines return a +** NULL pointer if [sqlite3_malloc()] is unable to allocate enough +** memory to hold the resulting string. +** +** {F17404} In sqlite3_snprintf() routine is similar to "snprintf()" from +** the standard C library. The result is written into the +** buffer supplied as the second parameter whose size is given by +** the first parameter. {END} Note that the order of the +** first two parameters is reversed from snprintf(). This is an +** historical accident that cannot be fixed without breaking +** backwards compatibility. {F17405} Note also that sqlite3_snprintf() +** returns a pointer to its buffer instead of the number of +** characters actually written into the buffer. {END} We admit that +** the number of characters written would be a more useful return +** value but we cannot change the implementation of sqlite3_snprintf() +** now without breaking compatibility. +** +** {F17406} As long as the buffer size is greater than zero, sqlite3_snprintf() +** guarantees that the buffer is always zero-terminated. {F17407} The first +** parameter "n" is the total size of the buffer, including space for +** the zero terminator. {END} So the longest string that can be completely +** written will be n-1 characters. +** +** These routines all implement some additional formatting +** options that are useful for constructing SQL statements. +** All of the usual printf formatting options apply. In addition, there +** is are "%q", "%Q", and "%z" options. +** +** {F17410} The %q option works like %s in that it substitutes a null-terminated +** string from the argument list. But %q also doubles every '\'' character. +** %q is designed for use inside a string literal. {END} By doubling each '\'' +** character it escapes that character and allows it to be inserted into +** the string. +** +** For example, so some string variable contains text as follows: +** +**
+**  char *zText = "It's a happy day!";
+** 
+** +** One can use this text in an SQL statement as follows: +** +**
+**  char *zSQL = sqlite3_mprintf("INSERT INTO table VALUES('%q')", zText);
+**  sqlite3_exec(db, zSQL, 0, 0, 0);
+**  sqlite3_free(zSQL);
+** 
+** +** Because the %q format string is used, the '\'' character in zText +** is escaped and the SQL generated is as follows: +** +**
+**  INSERT INTO table1 VALUES('It''s a happy day!')
+** 
+** +** This is correct. Had we used %s instead of %q, the generated SQL +** would have looked like this: +** +**
+**  INSERT INTO table1 VALUES('It's a happy day!');
+** 
+** +** This second example is an SQL syntax error. As a general rule you +** should always use %q instead of %s when inserting text into a string +** literal. +** +** {F17411} The %Q option works like %q except it also adds single quotes around +** the outside of the total string. Or if the parameter in the argument +** list is a NULL pointer, %Q substitutes the text "NULL" (without single +** quotes) in place of the %Q option. {END} So, for example, one could say: +** +**
+**  char *zSQL = sqlite3_mprintf("INSERT INTO table VALUES(%Q)", zText);
+**  sqlite3_exec(db, zSQL, 0, 0, 0);
+**  sqlite3_free(zSQL);
+** 
+** +** The code above will render a correct SQL statement in the zSQL +** variable even if the zText variable is a NULL pointer. +** +** {F17412} The "%z" formatting option works exactly like "%s" with the +** addition that after the string has been read and copied into +** the result, [sqlite3_free()] is called on the input string. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_mprintf(const char*,...); +SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_vmprintf(const char*, va_list); +SQLITE_API char *sqlite3_snprintf(int,char*,const char*, ...); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Memory Allocation Subsystem {F17300} +** +** {F17301} The SQLite core uses these three routines for all of its own +** internal memory allocation needs. {END} "Core" in the previous sentence +** does not include operating-system specific VFS implementation. The +** windows VFS uses native malloc and free for some operations. +** +** {F17302} The sqlite3_malloc() routine returns a pointer to a block +** of memory at least N bytes in length, where N is the parameter. +** {F17303} If sqlite3_malloc() is unable to obtain sufficient free +** memory, it returns a NULL pointer. {F17304} If the parameter N to +** sqlite3_malloc() is zero or negative then sqlite3_malloc() returns +** a NULL pointer. +** +** {F17305} Calling sqlite3_free() with a pointer previously returned +** by sqlite3_malloc() or sqlite3_realloc() releases that memory so +** that it might be reused. {F17306} The sqlite3_free() routine is +** a no-op if is called with a NULL pointer. Passing a NULL pointer +** to sqlite3_free() is harmless. {U17307} After being freed, memory +** should neither be read nor written. Even reading previously freed +** memory might result in a segmentation fault or other severe error. +** {U17309} Memory corruption, a segmentation fault, or other severe error +** might result if sqlite3_free() is called with a non-NULL pointer that +** was not obtained from sqlite3_malloc() or sqlite3_free(). +** +** {F17310} The sqlite3_realloc() interface attempts to resize a +** prior memory allocation to be at least N bytes, where N is the +** second parameter. The memory allocation to be resized is the first +** parameter. {F17311} If the first parameter to sqlite3_realloc() +** is a NULL pointer then its behavior is identical to calling +** sqlite3_malloc(N) where N is the second parameter to sqlite3_realloc(). +** {F17312} If the second parameter to sqlite3_realloc() is zero or +** negative then the behavior is exactly the same as calling +** sqlite3_free(P) where P is the first parameter to sqlite3_realloc(). +** {F17313} Sqlite3_realloc() returns a pointer to a memory allocation +** of at least N bytes in size or NULL if sufficient memory is unavailable. +** {F17314} If M is the size of the prior allocation, then min(N,M) bytes +** of the prior allocation are copied into the beginning of buffer returned +** by sqlite3_realloc() and the prior allocation is freed. +** {F17315} If sqlite3_realloc() returns NULL, then the prior allocation +** is not freed. +** +** {F17316} The memory returned by sqlite3_malloc() and sqlite3_realloc() +** is always aligned to at least an 8 byte boundary. {END} +** +** {F17381} The default implementation +** of the memory allocation subsystem uses the malloc(), realloc() +** and free() provided by the standard C library. {F17382} However, if +** SQLite is compiled with the following C preprocessor macro +** +**
SQLITE_MEMORY_SIZE=NNN
+** +** where NNN is an integer, then SQLite create a static +** array of at least NNN bytes in size and use that array +** for all of its dynamic memory allocation needs. {END} Additional +** memory allocator options may be added in future releases. +** +** In SQLite version 3.5.0 and 3.5.1, it was possible to define +** the SQLITE_OMIT_MEMORY_ALLOCATION which would cause the built-in +** implementation of these routines to be omitted. That capability +** is no longer provided. Only built-in memory allocators can be +** used. +** +** The windows OS interface layer calls +** the system malloc() and free() directly when converting +** filenames between the UTF-8 encoding used by SQLite +** and whatever filename encoding is used by the particular windows +** installation. Memory allocation errors are detected, but +** they are reported back as [SQLITE_CANTOPEN] or +** [SQLITE_IOERR] rather than [SQLITE_NOMEM]. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_malloc(int); +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_realloc(void*, int); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_free(void*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Memory Allocator Statistics {F17370} +** +** In addition to the basic three allocation routines +** [sqlite3_malloc()], [sqlite3_free()], and [sqlite3_realloc()], +** the memory allocation subsystem included with the SQLite +** sources provides the interfaces shown here. +** +** {F17371} The sqlite3_memory_used() routine returns the +** number of bytes of memory currently outstanding (malloced but not freed). +** {F17372} The value returned by sqlite3_memory_used() includes +** any overhead added by SQLite, but not overhead added by the +** library malloc() that backs the sqlite3_malloc() implementation. +** {F17373} The sqlite3_memory_highwater() routines returns the +** maximum number of bytes that have been outstanding at any time +** since the highwater mark was last reset. +** {F17374} The byte count returned by sqlite3_memory_highwater() +** uses the same byte counting rules as sqlite3_memory_used(). {END} +** In other words, overhead added internally by SQLite is counted, +** but overhead from the underlying system malloc is not. +** {F17375} If the parameter to sqlite3_memory_highwater() is true, +** then the highwater mark is reset to the current value of +** sqlite3_memory_used() and the prior highwater mark (before the +** reset) is returned. {F17376} If the parameter to +** sqlite3_memory_highwater() is zero, then the highwater mark is +** unchanged. +*/ +SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_memory_used(void); +SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_memory_highwater(int resetFlag); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Compile-Time Authorization Callbacks {F12500} +** +** {F12501} This routine registers a authorizer callback with a particular +** database connection, supplied in the first argument. {F12502} +** The authorizer callback is invoked as SQL statements are being compiled +** by [sqlite3_prepare()] or its variants [sqlite3_prepare_v2()], +** [sqlite3_prepare16()] and [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()]. {F12503} At various +** points during the compilation process, as logic is being created +** to perform various actions, the authorizer callback is invoked to +** see if those actions are allowed. The authorizer callback should +** return SQLITE_OK to allow the action, [SQLITE_IGNORE] to disallow the +** specific action but allow the SQL statement to continue to be +** compiled, or [SQLITE_DENY] to cause the entire SQL statement to be +** rejected with an error. {F12504} If the authorizer callback returns +** any value other than [SQLITE_IGNORE], [SQLITE_OK], or [SQLITE_DENY] +** then [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or equivalent call that triggered +** the authorizer shall +** fail with an SQLITE_ERROR error code and an appropriate error message. {END} +** +** When the callback returns [SQLITE_OK], that means the operation +** requested is ok. {F12505} When the callback returns [SQLITE_DENY], the +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or equivalent call that triggered the +** authorizer shall fail +** with an SQLITE_ERROR error code and an error message explaining that +** access is denied. {F12506} If the authorizer code (the 2nd parameter +** to the authorizer callback is anything other than [SQLITE_READ], then +** a return of [SQLITE_IGNORE] has the same effect as [SQLITE_DENY]. +** If the authorizer code is [SQLITE_READ] and the callback returns +** [SQLITE_IGNORE] then the prepared statement is constructed to +** insert a NULL value in place of the table column that would have +** been read if [SQLITE_OK] had been returned. {END} +** +** {F12510} The first parameter to the authorizer callback is a copy of +** the third parameter to the sqlite3_set_authorizer() interface. +** {F12511} The second parameter to the callback is an integer +** [SQLITE_COPY | action code] that specifies the particular action +** to be authorized. {END} The available action codes are +** [SQLITE_COPY | documented separately]. {F12512} The third through sixth +** parameters to the callback are zero-terminated strings that contain +** additional details about the action to be authorized. {END} +** +** An authorizer is used when preparing SQL statements from an untrusted +** source, to ensure that the SQL statements do not try to access data +** that they are not allowed to see, or that they do not try to +** execute malicious statements that damage the database. For +** example, an application may allow a user to enter arbitrary +** SQL queries for evaluation by a database. But the application does +** not want the user to be able to make arbitrary changes to the +** database. An authorizer could then be put in place while the +** user-entered SQL is being prepared that disallows everything +** except SELECT statements. +** +** {F12520} Only a single authorizer can be in place on a database connection +** at a time. Each call to sqlite3_set_authorizer overrides the +** previous call. {F12521} A NULL authorizer means that no authorization +** callback is invoked. {F12522} The default authorizer is NULL. {END} +** +** Note that the authorizer callback is invoked only during +** [sqlite3_prepare()] or its variants. {F12523} Authorization is not +** performed during statement evaluation in [sqlite3_step()]. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_set_authorizer( + sqlite3*, + int (*xAuth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,const char*), + void *pUserData +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Authorizer Return Codes {F12590} +** +** The [sqlite3_set_authorizer | authorizer callback function] must +** return either [SQLITE_OK] or one of these two constants in order +** to signal SQLite whether or not the action is permitted. See the +** [sqlite3_set_authorizer | authorizer documentation] for additional +** information. +*/ +#define SQLITE_DENY 1 /* Abort the SQL statement with an error */ +#define SQLITE_IGNORE 2 /* Don't allow access, but don't generate an error */ + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Authorizer Action Codes {F12550} +** +** The [sqlite3_set_authorizer()] interface registers a callback function +** that is invoked to authorizer certain SQL statement actions. {F12551} The +** second parameter to the callback is an integer code that specifies +** what action is being authorized. These are the integer action codes that +** the authorizer callback may be passed. {END} +** +** These action code values signify what kind of operation is to be +** authorized. {F12552} The 3rd and 4th parameters to the authorization +** callback function will be parameters or NULL depending on which of these +** codes is used as the second parameter. {F12553} The 5th parameter to the +** authorizer callback is the name of the database ("main", "temp", +** etc.) if applicable. {F12554} The 6th parameter to the authorizer callback +** is the name of the inner-most trigger or view that is responsible for +** the access attempt or NULL if this access attempt is directly from +** top-level SQL code. +*/ +/******************************************* 3rd ************ 4th ***********/ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_INDEX 1 /* Index Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_TABLE 2 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_INDEX 3 /* Index Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TABLE 4 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_TRIGGER 5 /* Trigger Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_TEMP_VIEW 6 /* View Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_TRIGGER 7 /* Trigger Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_VIEW 8 /* View Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_DELETE 9 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_INDEX 10 /* Index Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_TABLE 11 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_INDEX 12 /* Index Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TABLE 13 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_TRIGGER 14 /* Trigger Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_TEMP_VIEW 15 /* View Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_TRIGGER 16 /* Trigger Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_VIEW 17 /* View Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_INSERT 18 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_PRAGMA 19 /* Pragma Name 1st arg or NULL */ +#define SQLITE_READ 20 /* Table Name Column Name */ +#define SQLITE_SELECT 21 /* NULL NULL */ +#define SQLITE_TRANSACTION 22 /* NULL NULL */ +#define SQLITE_UPDATE 23 /* Table Name Column Name */ +#define SQLITE_ATTACH 24 /* Filename NULL */ +#define SQLITE_DETACH 25 /* Database Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_ALTER_TABLE 26 /* Database Name Table Name */ +#define SQLITE_REINDEX 27 /* Index Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_ANALYZE 28 /* Table Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_CREATE_VTABLE 29 /* Table Name Module Name */ +#define SQLITE_DROP_VTABLE 30 /* Table Name Module Name */ +#define SQLITE_FUNCTION 31 /* Function Name NULL */ +#define SQLITE_COPY 0 /* No longer used */ + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Tracing And Profiling Functions {F12280} +** +** These routines register callback functions that can be used for +** tracing and profiling the execution of SQL statements. +** +** {F12281} The callback function registered by sqlite3_trace() is invoked +** at the first [sqlite3_step()] for the evaluation of an SQL statement. +** {F12282} Only a single trace callback can be registered at a time. +** Each call to sqlite3_trace() overrides the previous. {F12283} A +** NULL callback for sqlite3_trace() disables tracing. {F12284} The +** first argument to the trace callback is a copy of the pointer which +** was the 3rd argument to sqlite3_trace. {F12285} The second argument +** to the trace callback is a zero-terminated UTF8 string containing +** the original text of the SQL statement as it was passed into +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or the equivalent. {END} Note that the +** host parameter are not expanded in the SQL statement text. +** +** {F12287} The callback function registered by sqlite3_profile() is invoked +** as each SQL statement finishes. {F12288} The first parameter to the +** profile callback is a copy of the 3rd parameter to sqlite3_profile(). +** {F12289} The second parameter to the profile callback is a +** zero-terminated UTF-8 string that contains the complete text of +** the SQL statement as it was processed by [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or +** the equivalent. {F12290} The third parameter to the profile +** callback is an estimate of the number of nanoseconds of +** wall-clock time required to run the SQL statement from start +** to finish. {END} +** +** The sqlite3_profile() API is currently considered experimental and +** is subject to change. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_trace(sqlite3*, void(*xTrace)(void*,const char*), void*); +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_profile(sqlite3*, + void(*xProfile)(void*,const char*,sqlite3_uint64), void*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Query Progress Callbacks {F12910} +** +** {F12911} This routine configures a callback function - the +** progress callback - that is invoked periodically during long +** running calls to [sqlite3_exec()], [sqlite3_step()] and +** [sqlite3_get_table()]. {END} An example use for this +** interface is to keep a GUI updated during a large query. +** +** {F12912} The progress callback is invoked once for every N virtual +** machine opcodes, where N is the second argument to this function. +** {F12913} The progress callback itself is identified by the third +** argument to this function. {F12914} The fourth argument to this +** function is a void pointer passed to the progress callback +** function each time it is invoked. {END} +** +** {F12915} If a call to [sqlite3_exec()], [sqlite3_step()], or +** [sqlite3_get_table()] results in fewer than N opcodes being executed, +** then the progress callback is never invoked. {END} +** +** {F12916} Only a single progress callback function may be registered for each +** open database connection. Every call to sqlite3_progress_handler() +** overwrites the results of the previous call. {F12917} +** To remove the progress callback altogether, pass NULL as the third +** argument to this function. {END} +** +** {F12918} If the progress callback returns a result other than 0, then +** the current query is immediately terminated and any database changes +** rolled back. {F12919} +** The containing [sqlite3_exec()], [sqlite3_step()], or +** [sqlite3_get_table()] call returns SQLITE_INTERRUPT. {END} This feature +** can be used, for example, to implement the "Cancel" button on a +** progress dialog box in a GUI. +*/ +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_progress_handler(sqlite3*, int, int(*)(void*), void*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Opening A New Database Connection {F12700} +** +** {F12701} These routines open an SQLite database file whose name +** is given by the filename argument. +** {F12702} The filename argument is interpreted as UTF-8 +** for [sqlite3_open()] and [sqlite3_open_v2()] and as UTF-16 +** in the native byte order for [sqlite3_open16()]. +** {F12703} An [sqlite3*] handle is returned in *ppDb, even +** if an error occurs. {F12723} (Exception: if SQLite is unable +** to allocate memory to hold the [sqlite3] object, a NULL will +** be written into *ppDb instead of a pointer to the [sqlite3] object.) +** {F12704} If the database is opened (and/or created) +** successfully, then [SQLITE_OK] is returned. {F12705} Otherwise an +** error code is returned. {F12706} The +** [sqlite3_errmsg()] or [sqlite3_errmsg16()] routines can be used to obtain +** an English language description of the error. +** +** {F12707} The default encoding for the database will be UTF-8 if +** [sqlite3_open()] or [sqlite3_open_v2()] is called and +** UTF-16 in the native byte order if [sqlite3_open16()] is used. +** +** {F12708} Whether or not an error occurs when it is opened, resources +** associated with the [sqlite3*] handle should be released by passing it +** to [sqlite3_close()] when it is no longer required. +** +** {F12709} The [sqlite3_open_v2()] interface works like [sqlite3_open()] +** except that it acccepts two additional parameters for additional control +** over the new database connection. {F12710} The flags parameter can be +** one of: +** +**
    +**
  1. [SQLITE_OPEN_READONLY] +**
  2. [SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE] +**
  3. [SQLITE_OPEN_READWRITE] | [SQLITE_OPEN_CREATE] +**
+** +** {F12711} The first value opens the database read-only. +** {F12712} If the database does not previously exist, an error is returned. +** {F12713} The second option opens +** the database for reading and writing if possible, or reading only if +** if the file is write protected. {F12714} In either case the database +** must already exist or an error is returned. {F12715} The third option +** opens the database for reading and writing and creates it if it does +** not already exist. {F12716} +** The third options is behavior that is always used for [sqlite3_open()] +** and [sqlite3_open16()]. +** +** {F12717} If the filename is ":memory:", then an private +** in-memory database is created for the connection. {F12718} This in-memory +** database will vanish when the database connection is closed. {END} Future +** version of SQLite might make use of additional special filenames +** that begin with the ":" character. It is recommended that +** when a database filename really does begin with +** ":" that you prefix the filename with a pathname like "./" to +** avoid ambiguity. +** +** {F12719} If the filename is an empty string, then a private temporary +** on-disk database will be created. {F12720} This private database will be +** automatically deleted as soon as the database connection is closed. +** +** {F12721} The fourth parameter to sqlite3_open_v2() is the name of the +** [sqlite3_vfs] object that defines the operating system +** interface that the new database connection should use. {F12722} If the +** fourth parameter is a NULL pointer then the default [sqlite3_vfs] +** object is used. {END} +** +** Note to windows users: The encoding used for the filename argument +** of [sqlite3_open()] and [sqlite3_open_v2()] must be UTF-8, not whatever +** codepage is currently defined. Filenames containing international +** characters must be converted to UTF-8 prior to passing them into +** [sqlite3_open()] or [sqlite3_open_v2()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open( + const char *filename, /* Database filename (UTF-8) */ + sqlite3 **ppDb /* OUT: SQLite db handle */ +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open16( + const void *filename, /* Database filename (UTF-16) */ + sqlite3 **ppDb /* OUT: SQLite db handle */ +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_open_v2( + const char *filename, /* Database filename (UTF-8) */ + sqlite3 **ppDb, /* OUT: SQLite db handle */ + int flags, /* Flags */ + const char *zVfs /* Name of VFS module to use */ +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Error Codes And Messages {F12800} +** +** {F12801} The sqlite3_errcode() interface returns the numeric +** [SQLITE_OK | result code] or [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended result code] +** for the most recent failed sqlite3_* API call associated +** with [sqlite3] handle 'db'. {U12802} If a prior API call failed but the +** most recent API call succeeded, the return value from sqlite3_errcode() +** is undefined. {END} +** +** {F12803} The sqlite3_errmsg() and sqlite3_errmsg16() return English-language +** text that describes the error, as either UTF8 or UTF16 respectively. +** {F12804} Memory to hold the error message string is managed internally. +** {U12805} The +** string may be overwritten or deallocated by subsequent calls to SQLite +** interface functions. {END} +** +** {F12806} Calls to many sqlite3_* functions set the error code and +** string returned by [sqlite3_errcode()], [sqlite3_errmsg()], and +** [sqlite3_errmsg16()] overwriting the previous values. {F12807} +** Except, calls to [sqlite3_errcode()], +** [sqlite3_errmsg()], and [sqlite3_errmsg16()] themselves do not affect the +** results of future invocations. {F12808} Calls to API routines that +** do not return an error code (example: [sqlite3_data_count()]) do not +** change the error code returned by this routine. {F12809} Interfaces that +** are not associated with a specific database connection (examples: +** [sqlite3_mprintf()] or [sqlite3_enable_shared_cache()] do not change +** the return code. {END} +** +** {F12810} Assuming no other intervening sqlite3_* API calls are made, +** the error code returned by this function is associated with the same +** error as the strings returned by [sqlite3_errmsg()] and [sqlite3_errmsg16()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_errcode(sqlite3 *db); +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_errmsg(sqlite3*); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_errmsg16(sqlite3*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: SQL Statement Object {F13000} +** +** An instance of this object represent single SQL statements. This +** object is variously known as a "prepared statement" or a +** "compiled SQL statement" or simply as a "statement". +** +** The life of a statement object goes something like this: +** +**
    +**
  1. Create the object using [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or a related +** function. +**
  2. Bind values to host parameters using +** [sqlite3_bind_blob | sqlite3_bind_* interfaces]. +**
  3. Run the SQL by calling [sqlite3_step()] one or more times. +**
  4. Reset the statement using [sqlite3_reset()] then go back +** to step 2. Do this zero or more times. +**
  5. Destroy the object using [sqlite3_finalize()]. +**
+** +** Refer to documentation on individual methods above for additional +** information. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_stmt sqlite3_stmt; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Compiling An SQL Statement {F13010} +** +** To execute an SQL query, it must first be compiled into a byte-code +** program using one of these routines. +** +** {F13011} The first argument "db" is an [sqlite3 | SQLite database handle] +** obtained from a prior call to [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open_v2()] +** or [sqlite3_open16()]. {F13012} +** The second argument "zSql" is the statement to be compiled, encoded +** as either UTF-8 or UTF-16. The sqlite3_prepare() and sqlite3_prepare_v2() +** interfaces uses UTF-8 and sqlite3_prepare16() and sqlite3_prepare16_v2() +** use UTF-16. {END} +** +** {F13013} If the nByte argument is less +** than zero, then zSql is read up to the first zero terminator. +** {F13014} If nByte is non-negative, then it is the maximum number of +** bytes read from zSql. When nByte is non-negative, the +** zSql string ends at either the first '\000' or '\u0000' character or +** until the nByte-th byte, whichever comes first. {END} +** +** {F13015} *pzTail is made to point to the first byte past the end of the +** first SQL statement in zSql. These routines only compiles the first +** statement in zSql, so *pzTail is left pointing to what remains +** uncompiled. {END} +** +** {F13016} *ppStmt is left pointing to a compiled +** [sqlite3_stmt | SQL statement structure] that can be +** executed using [sqlite3_step()]. Or if there is an error, *ppStmt may be +** set to NULL. {F13017} If the input text contains no SQL (if the input +** is and empty string or a comment) then *ppStmt is set to NULL. +** {U13018} The calling procedure is responsible for deleting the +** compiled SQL statement +** using [sqlite3_finalize()] after it has finished with it. +** +** {F13019} On success, [SQLITE_OK] is returned. Otherwise an +** [SQLITE_ERROR | error code] is returned. {END} +** +** The sqlite3_prepare_v2() and sqlite3_prepare16_v2() interfaces are +** recommended for all new programs. The two older interfaces are retained +** for backwards compatibility, but their use is discouraged. +** {F13020} In the "v2" interfaces, the prepared statement +** that is returned (the [sqlite3_stmt] object) contains a copy of the +** original SQL text. {END} This causes the [sqlite3_step()] interface to +** behave a differently in two ways: +** +**
    +**
  1. {F13022} +** If the database schema changes, instead of returning [SQLITE_SCHEMA] as it +** always used to do, [sqlite3_step()] will automatically recompile the SQL +** statement and try to run it again. {F12023} If the schema has changed in +** a way that makes the statement no longer valid, [sqlite3_step()] will still +** return [SQLITE_SCHEMA]. {END} But unlike the legacy behavior, +** [SQLITE_SCHEMA] is now a fatal error. {F12024} Calling +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] again will not make the +** error go away. {F12025} Note: use [sqlite3_errmsg()] to find the text +** of the parsing error that results in an [SQLITE_SCHEMA] return. {END} +**
  2. +** +**
  3. +** {F13030} When an error occurs, +** [sqlite3_step()] will return one of the detailed +** [SQLITE_ERROR | result codes] or +** [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended result codes]. {F13031} +** The legacy behavior was that [sqlite3_step()] would only return a generic +** [SQLITE_ERROR] result code and you would have to make a second call to +** [sqlite3_reset()] in order to find the underlying cause of the problem. +** {F13032} +** With the "v2" prepare interfaces, the underlying reason for the error is +** returned immediately. {END} +**
  4. +**
+*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare( + sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */ + const char *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-8 encoded */ + int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */ + sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */ + const char **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */ +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare_v2( + sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */ + const char *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-8 encoded */ + int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */ + sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */ + const char **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */ +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare16( + sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */ + const void *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-16 encoded */ + int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */ + sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */ + const void **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */ +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_prepare16_v2( + sqlite3 *db, /* Database handle */ + const void *zSql, /* SQL statement, UTF-16 encoded */ + int nByte, /* Maximum length of zSql in bytes. */ + sqlite3_stmt **ppStmt, /* OUT: Statement handle */ + const void **pzTail /* OUT: Pointer to unused portion of zSql */ +); + +/* +** CAPIREF: Retrieving Statement SQL {F13100} +** +** {F13101} If the compiled SQL statement passed as an argument was +** compiled using either [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()], +** then this function returns a pointer to a zero-terminated string +** containing a copy of the original SQL statement. {F13102} The +** pointer is valid until the statement +** is deleted using sqlite3_finalize(). +** {F13103} The string returned by sqlite3_sql() is always UTF8 even +** if a UTF16 string was originally entered using [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] +** or the equivalent. +** +** {F13104} If the statement was compiled using either of the legacy +** interfaces [sqlite3_prepare()] or [sqlite3_prepare16()], this +** function returns NULL. +*/ +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_sql(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Dynamically Typed Value Object {F15000} +** +** {F15001} SQLite uses the sqlite3_value object to represent all values +** that are or can be stored in a database table. {END} +** SQLite uses dynamic typing for the values it stores. +** {F15002} Values stored in sqlite3_value objects can be +** be integers, floating point values, strings, BLOBs, or NULL. +*/ +typedef struct Mem sqlite3_value; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: SQL Function Context Object {F16001} +** +** The context in which an SQL function executes is stored in an +** sqlite3_context object. {F16002} A pointer to an sqlite3_context +** object is always first parameter to application-defined SQL functions. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_context sqlite3_context; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Binding Values To Prepared Statements {F13500} +** +** {F13501} In the SQL strings input to [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and its +** variants, literals may be replace by a parameter in one +** of these forms: +** +**
    +**
  • ? +**
  • ?NNN +**
  • :AAA +**
  • @AAA +**
  • $VVV +**
+** +** In the parameter forms shown above NNN is an integer literal, +** AAA is an alphanumeric identifier and VVV is a variable name according +** to the syntax rules of the TCL programming language. {END} +** The values of these parameters (also called "host parameter names") +** can be set using the sqlite3_bind_*() routines defined here. +** +** {F13502} The first argument to the sqlite3_bind_*() routines always +** is a pointer to the [sqlite3_stmt] object returned from +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or its variants. {F13503} The second +** argument is the index of the parameter to be set. {F13504} The +** first parameter has an index of 1. {F13505} When the same named +** parameter is used more than once, second and subsequent +** occurrences have the same index as the first occurrence. +** {F13506} The index for named parameters can be looked up using the +** [sqlite3_bind_parameter_name()] API if desired. {F13507} The index +** for "?NNN" parameters is the value of NNN. +** {F13508} The NNN value must be between 1 and the compile-time +** parameter SQLITE_MAX_VARIABLE_NUMBER (default value: 999). {END} +** See limits.html for additional information. +** +** {F13509} The third argument is the value to bind to the parameter. {END} +** +** {F13510} In those +** routines that have a fourth argument, its value is the number of bytes +** in the parameter. To be clear: the value is the number of bytes in the +** string, not the number of characters. {F13511} The number +** of bytes does not include the zero-terminator at the end of strings. +** {F13512} +** If the fourth parameter is negative, the length of the string is +** number of bytes up to the first zero terminator. {END} +** +** {F13513} +** The fifth argument to sqlite3_bind_blob(), sqlite3_bind_text(), and +** sqlite3_bind_text16() is a destructor used to dispose of the BLOB or +** text after SQLite has finished with it. {F13514} If the fifth argument is +** the special value [SQLITE_STATIC], then the library assumes that the +** information is in static, unmanaged space and does not need to be freed. +** {F13515} If the fifth argument has the value [SQLITE_TRANSIENT], then +** SQLite makes its own private copy of the data immediately, before +** the sqlite3_bind_*() routine returns. {END} +** +** {F13520} The sqlite3_bind_zeroblob() routine binds a BLOB of length N that +** is filled with zeros. {F13521} A zeroblob uses a fixed amount of memory +** (just an integer to hold it size) while it is being processed. {END} +** Zeroblobs are intended to serve as place-holders for BLOBs whose +** content is later written using +** [sqlite3_blob_open | increment BLOB I/O] routines. {F13522} A negative +** value for the zeroblob results in a zero-length BLOB. {END} +** +** {F13530} The sqlite3_bind_*() routines must be called after +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] (and its variants) or [sqlite3_reset()] and +** before [sqlite3_step()]. {F13531} +** Bindings are not cleared by the [sqlite3_reset()] routine. +** {F13532} Unbound parameters are interpreted as NULL. {END} +** +** {F13540} These routines return [SQLITE_OK] on success or an error code if +** anything goes wrong. {F13541} [SQLITE_RANGE] is returned if the parameter +** index is out of range. {F13542} [SQLITE_NOMEM] is returned if malloc fails. +** {F13543} [SQLITE_MISUSE] is returned if these routines are called on a +** virtual machine that is the wrong state or which has already been finalized. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_blob(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const void*, int n, void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_double(sqlite3_stmt*, int, double); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_int(sqlite3_stmt*, int, int); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_int64(sqlite3_stmt*, int, sqlite3_int64); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_null(sqlite3_stmt*, int); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_text(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const char*, int n, void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_text16(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const void*, int, void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_value(sqlite3_stmt*, int, const sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_zeroblob(sqlite3_stmt*, int, int n); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Number Of Host Parameters {F13600} +** +** {F13601} Return the largest host parameter index in the precompiled +** statement given as the argument. {F13602} When the host parameters +** are of the forms like ":AAA", "$VVV", "@AAA", or "?", +** then they are assigned sequential increasing numbers beginning +** with one, so the value returned is the number of parameters. +** {F13603} However +** if the same host parameter name is used multiple times, each occurrance +** is given the same number, so the value returned in that case is the number +** of unique host parameter names. {F13604} If host parameters of the +** form "?NNN" are used (where NNN is an integer) then there might be +** gaps in the numbering and the value returned by this interface is +** the index of the host parameter with the largest index value. {END} +** +** {U13605} The prepared statement must not be [sqlite3_finalize | finalized] +** prior to this routine returning. Otherwise the results are undefined +** and probably undesirable. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_parameter_count(sqlite3_stmt*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Name Of A Host Parameter {F13620} +** +** {F13621} This routine returns a pointer to the name of the n-th +** parameter in a [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement]. {F13622} +** Host parameters of the form ":AAA" or "@AAA" or "$VVV" have a name +** which is the string ":AAA" or "@AAA" or "$VVV". +** In other words, the initial ":" or "$" or "@" +** is included as part of the name. {F13626} +** Parameters of the form "?" or "?NNN" have no name. +** +** {F13623} The first host parameter has an index of 1, not 0. +** +** {F13624} If the value n is out of range or if the n-th parameter is +** nameless, then NULL is returned. {F13625} The returned string is +** always in the UTF-8 encoding even if the named parameter was +** originally specified as UTF-16 in [sqlite3_prepare16()] or +** [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_bind_parameter_name(sqlite3_stmt*, int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Index Of A Parameter With A Given Name {F13640} +** +** {F13641} This routine returns the index of a host parameter with the +** given name. {F13642} The name must match exactly. {F13643} +** If no parameter with the given name is found, return 0. +** {F13644} Parameter names must be UTF8. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_bind_parameter_index(sqlite3_stmt*, const char *zName); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Reset All Bindings On A Prepared Statement {F13660} +** +** {F13661} Contrary to the intuition of many, [sqlite3_reset()] does not +** reset the [sqlite3_bind_blob | bindings] on a +** [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement]. {F13662} Use this routine to +** reset all host parameters to NULL. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_clear_bindings(sqlite3_stmt*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Number Of Columns In A Result Set {F13710} +** +** {F13711} Return the number of columns in the result set returned by the +** [sqlite3_stmt | compiled SQL statement]. {F13712} This routine returns 0 +** if pStmt is an SQL statement that does not return data (for +** example an UPDATE). +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_count(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Column Names In A Result Set {F13720} +** +** {F13721} These routines return the name assigned to a particular column +** in the result set of a SELECT statement. {F13722} The sqlite3_column_name() +** interface returns a pointer to a zero-terminated UTF8 string +** and sqlite3_column_name16() returns a pointer to a zero-terminated +** UTF16 string. {F13723} The first parameter is the +** [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement] that implements the SELECT statement. +** The second parameter is the column number. The left-most column is +** number 0. +** +** {F13724} The returned string pointer is valid until either the +** [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement] is destroyed by [sqlite3_finalize()] +** or until the next call sqlite3_column_name() or sqlite3_column_name16() +** on the same column. +** +** {F13725} If sqlite3_malloc() fails during the processing of either routine +** (for example during a conversion from UTF-8 to UTF-16) then a +** NULL pointer is returned. +*/ +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_name(sqlite3_stmt*, int N); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_name16(sqlite3_stmt*, int N); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Source Of Data In A Query Result {F13740} +** +** {F13741} These routines provide a means to determine what column of what +** table in which database a result of a SELECT statement comes from. +** {F13742} The name of the database or table or column can be returned as +** either a UTF8 or UTF16 string. {F13743} The _database_ routines return +** the database name, the _table_ routines return the table name, and +** the origin_ routines return the column name. {F13744} +** The returned string is valid until +** the [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement] is destroyed using +** [sqlite3_finalize()] or until the same information is requested +** again in a different encoding. +** +** {F13745} The names returned are the original un-aliased names of the +** database, table, and column. +** +** {F13746} The first argument to the following calls is a +** [sqlite3_stmt | compiled SQL statement]. +** {F13747} These functions return information about the Nth column returned by +** the statement, where N is the second function argument. +** +** {F13748} If the Nth column returned by the statement is an expression +** or subquery and is not a column value, then all of these functions +** return NULL. {F13749} Otherwise, they return the +** name of the attached database, table and column that query result +** column was extracted from. +** +** {F13750} As with all other SQLite APIs, those postfixed with "16" return +** UTF-16 encoded strings, the other functions return UTF-8. {END} +** +** These APIs are only available if the library was compiled with the +** SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_METADATA preprocessor symbol defined. +** +** {U13751} +** If two or more threads call one or more of these routines against the same +** prepared statement and column at the same time then the results are +** undefined. +*/ +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_database_name(sqlite3_stmt*,int); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_database_name16(sqlite3_stmt*,int); +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_table_name(sqlite3_stmt*,int); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_table_name16(sqlite3_stmt*,int); +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_origin_name(sqlite3_stmt*,int); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_origin_name16(sqlite3_stmt*,int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Declared Datatype Of A Query Result {F13760} +** +** The first parameter is a [sqlite3_stmt | compiled SQL statement]. +** {F13761} If this statement is a SELECT statement and the Nth column of the +** returned result set of that SELECT is a table column (not an +** expression or subquery) then the declared type of the table +** column is returned. {F13762} If the Nth column of the result set is an +** expression or subquery, then a NULL pointer is returned. +** {F13763} The returned string is always UTF-8 encoded. {END} +** For example, in the database schema: +** +** CREATE TABLE t1(c1 VARIANT); +** +** And the following statement compiled: +** +** SELECT c1 + 1, c1 FROM t1; +** +** Then this routine would return the string "VARIANT" for the second +** result column (i==1), and a NULL pointer for the first result column +** (i==0). +** +** SQLite uses dynamic run-time typing. So just because a column +** is declared to contain a particular type does not mean that the +** data stored in that column is of the declared type. SQLite is +** strongly typed, but the typing is dynamic not static. Type +** is associated with individual values, not with the containers +** used to hold those values. +*/ +SQLITE_API const char *sqlite3_column_decltype(sqlite3_stmt *, int i); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_decltype16(sqlite3_stmt*,int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Evaluate An SQL Statement {F13200} +** +** After an [sqlite3_stmt | SQL statement] has been prepared with a call +** to either [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] or to one of +** the legacy interfaces [sqlite3_prepare()] or [sqlite3_prepare16()], +** then this function must be called one or more times to evaluate the +** statement. +** +** The details of the behavior of this sqlite3_step() interface depend +** on whether the statement was prepared using the newer "v2" interface +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] and [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] or the older legacy +** interface [sqlite3_prepare()] and [sqlite3_prepare16()]. The use of the +** new "v2" interface is recommended for new applications but the legacy +** interface will continue to be supported. +** +** In the lagacy interface, the return value will be either [SQLITE_BUSY], +** [SQLITE_DONE], [SQLITE_ROW], [SQLITE_ERROR], or [SQLITE_MISUSE]. +** With the "v2" interface, any of the other [SQLITE_OK | result code] +** or [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended result code] might be returned as +** well. +** +** [SQLITE_BUSY] means that the database engine was unable to acquire the +** database locks it needs to do its job. If the statement is a COMMIT +** or occurs outside of an explicit transaction, then you can retry the +** statement. If the statement is not a COMMIT and occurs within a +** explicit transaction then you should rollback the transaction before +** continuing. +** +** [SQLITE_DONE] means that the statement has finished executing +** successfully. sqlite3_step() should not be called again on this virtual +** machine without first calling [sqlite3_reset()] to reset the virtual +** machine back to its initial state. +** +** If the SQL statement being executed returns any data, then +** [SQLITE_ROW] is returned each time a new row of data is ready +** for processing by the caller. The values may be accessed using +** the [sqlite3_column_int | column access functions]. +** sqlite3_step() is called again to retrieve the next row of data. +** +** [SQLITE_ERROR] means that a run-time error (such as a constraint +** violation) has occurred. sqlite3_step() should not be called again on +** the VM. More information may be found by calling [sqlite3_errmsg()]. +** With the legacy interface, a more specific error code (example: +** [SQLITE_INTERRUPT], [SQLITE_SCHEMA], [SQLITE_CORRUPT], and so forth) +** can be obtained by calling [sqlite3_reset()] on the +** [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement]. In the "v2" interface, +** the more specific error code is returned directly by sqlite3_step(). +** +** [SQLITE_MISUSE] means that the this routine was called inappropriately. +** Perhaps it was called on a [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement] that has +** already been [sqlite3_finalize | finalized] or on one that had +** previously returned [SQLITE_ERROR] or [SQLITE_DONE]. Or it could +** be the case that the same database connection is being used by two or +** more threads at the same moment in time. +** +** Goofy Interface Alert: +** In the legacy interface, +** the sqlite3_step() API always returns a generic error code, +** [SQLITE_ERROR], following any error other than [SQLITE_BUSY] +** and [SQLITE_MISUSE]. You must call [sqlite3_reset()] or +** [sqlite3_finalize()] in order to find one of the specific +** [SQLITE_ERROR | result codes] that better describes the error. +** We admit that this is a goofy design. The problem has been fixed +** with the "v2" interface. If you prepare all of your SQL statements +** using either [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or [sqlite3_prepare16_v2()] instead +** of the legacy [sqlite3_prepare()] and [sqlite3_prepare16()], then the +** more specific [SQLITE_ERROR | result codes] are returned directly +** by sqlite3_step(). The use of the "v2" interface is recommended. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_step(sqlite3_stmt*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Number of columns in a result set {F13770} +** +** Return the number of values in the current row of the result set. +** +** {F13771} After a call to [sqlite3_step()] that returns [SQLITE_ROW], +** this routine +** will return the same value as the [sqlite3_column_count()] function. +** {F13772} +** After [sqlite3_step()] has returned an [SQLITE_DONE], [SQLITE_BUSY], or +** a [SQLITE_ERROR | error code], or before [sqlite3_step()] has been +** called on the [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement] for the first time, +** this routine returns zero. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_data_count(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Fundamental Datatypes {F10265} +** +** {F10266}Every value in SQLite has one of five fundamental datatypes: +** +**
    +**
  • 64-bit signed integer +**
  • 64-bit IEEE floating point number +**
  • string +**
  • BLOB +**
  • NULL +**
{END} +** +** These constants are codes for each of those types. +** +** Note that the SQLITE_TEXT constant was also used in SQLite version 2 +** for a completely different meaning. Software that links against both +** SQLite version 2 and SQLite version 3 should use SQLITE3_TEXT not +** SQLITE_TEXT. +*/ +#define SQLITE_INTEGER 1 +#define SQLITE_FLOAT 2 +#define SQLITE_BLOB 4 +#define SQLITE_NULL 5 +#ifdef SQLITE_TEXT +# undef SQLITE_TEXT +#else +# define SQLITE_TEXT 3 +#endif +#define SQLITE3_TEXT 3 + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Results Values From A Query {F13800} +** +** These routines return information about +** a single column of the current result row of a query. In every +** case the first argument is a pointer to the +** [sqlite3_stmt | SQL statement] that is being +** evaluated (the [sqlite3_stmt*] that was returned from +** [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or one of its variants) and +** the second argument is the index of the column for which information +** should be returned. The left-most column of the result set +** has an index of 0. +** +** If the SQL statement is not currently point to a valid row, or if the +** the column index is out of range, the result is undefined. +** These routines may only be called when the most recent call to +** [sqlite3_step()] has returned [SQLITE_ROW] and neither +** [sqlite3_reset()] nor [sqlite3_finalize()] has been call subsequently. +** If any of these routines are called after [sqlite3_reset()] or +** [sqlite3_finalize()] or after [sqlite3_step()] has returned +** something other than [SQLITE_ROW], the results are undefined. +** If [sqlite3_step()] or [sqlite3_reset()] or [sqlite3_finalize()] +** are called from a different thread while any of these routines +** are pending, then the results are undefined. +** +** The sqlite3_column_type() routine returns +** [SQLITE_INTEGER | datatype code] for the initial data type +** of the result column. The returned value is one of [SQLITE_INTEGER], +** [SQLITE_FLOAT], [SQLITE_TEXT], [SQLITE_BLOB], or [SQLITE_NULL]. The value +** returned by sqlite3_column_type() is only meaningful if no type +** conversions have occurred as described below. After a type conversion, +** the value returned by sqlite3_column_type() is undefined. Future +** versions of SQLite may change the behavior of sqlite3_column_type() +** following a type conversion. +** +** If the result is a BLOB or UTF-8 string then the sqlite3_column_bytes() +** routine returns the number of bytes in that BLOB or string. +** If the result is a UTF-16 string, then sqlite3_column_bytes() converts +** the string to UTF-8 and then returns the number of bytes. +** If the result is a numeric value then sqlite3_column_bytes() uses +** [sqlite3_snprintf()] to convert that value to a UTF-8 string and returns +** the number of bytes in that string. +** The value returned does not include the zero terminator at the end +** of the string. For clarity: the value returned is the number of +** bytes in the string, not the number of characters. +** +** Strings returned by sqlite3_column_text() and sqlite3_column_text16(), +** even zero-length strings, are always zero terminated. The return +** value from sqlite3_column_blob() for a zero-length blob is an arbitrary +** pointer, possibly even a NULL pointer. +** +** The sqlite3_column_bytes16() routine is similar to sqlite3_column_bytes() +** but leaves the result in UTF-16 instead of UTF-8. +** The zero terminator is not included in this count. +** +** These routines attempt to convert the value where appropriate. For +** example, if the internal representation is FLOAT and a text result +** is requested, [sqlite3_snprintf()] is used internally to do the conversion +** automatically. The following table details the conversions that +** are applied: +** +**
+** +**
Internal
Type
Requested
Type
Conversion +** +**
NULL INTEGER Result is 0 +**
NULL FLOAT Result is 0.0 +**
NULL TEXT Result is NULL pointer +**
NULL BLOB Result is NULL pointer +**
INTEGER FLOAT Convert from integer to float +**
INTEGER TEXT ASCII rendering of the integer +**
INTEGER BLOB Same as for INTEGER->TEXT +**
FLOAT INTEGER Convert from float to integer +**
FLOAT TEXT ASCII rendering of the float +**
FLOAT BLOB Same as FLOAT->TEXT +**
TEXT INTEGER Use atoi() +**
TEXT FLOAT Use atof() +**
TEXT BLOB No change +**
BLOB INTEGER Convert to TEXT then use atoi() +**
BLOB FLOAT Convert to TEXT then use atof() +**
BLOB TEXT Add a zero terminator if needed +**
+**
+** +** The table above makes reference to standard C library functions atoi() +** and atof(). SQLite does not really use these functions. It has its +** on equavalent internal routines. The atoi() and atof() names are +** used in the table for brevity and because they are familiar to most +** C programmers. +** +** Note that when type conversions occur, pointers returned by prior +** calls to sqlite3_column_blob(), sqlite3_column_text(), and/or +** sqlite3_column_text16() may be invalidated. +** Type conversions and pointer invalidations might occur +** in the following cases: +** +**
    +**
  • The initial content is a BLOB and sqlite3_column_text() +** or sqlite3_column_text16() is called. A zero-terminator might +** need to be added to the string.

  • +** +**
  • The initial content is UTF-8 text and sqlite3_column_bytes16() or +** sqlite3_column_text16() is called. The content must be converted +** to UTF-16.

  • +** +**
  • The initial content is UTF-16 text and sqlite3_column_bytes() or +** sqlite3_column_text() is called. The content must be converted +** to UTF-8.

  • +**
+** +** Conversions between UTF-16be and UTF-16le are always done in place and do +** not invalidate a prior pointer, though of course the content of the buffer +** that the prior pointer points to will have been modified. Other kinds +** of conversion are done in place when it is possible, but sometime it is +** not possible and in those cases prior pointers are invalidated. +** +** The safest and easiest to remember policy is to invoke these routines +** in one of the following ways: +** +**
    +**
  • sqlite3_column_text() followed by sqlite3_column_bytes()
  • +**
  • sqlite3_column_blob() followed by sqlite3_column_bytes()
  • +**
  • sqlite3_column_text16() followed by sqlite3_column_bytes16()
  • +**
+** +** In other words, you should call sqlite3_column_text(), sqlite3_column_blob(), +** or sqlite3_column_text16() first to force the result into the desired +** format, then invoke sqlite3_column_bytes() or sqlite3_column_bytes16() to +** find the size of the result. Do not mix call to sqlite3_column_text() or +** sqlite3_column_blob() with calls to sqlite3_column_bytes16(). And do not +** mix calls to sqlite3_column_text16() with calls to sqlite3_column_bytes(). +** +** The pointers returned are valid until a type conversion occurs as +** described above, or until [sqlite3_step()] or [sqlite3_reset()] or +** [sqlite3_finalize()] is called. The memory space used to hold strings +** and blobs is freed automatically. Do not pass the pointers returned +** [sqlite3_column_blob()], [sqlite3_column_text()], etc. into +** [sqlite3_free()]. +** +** If a memory allocation error occurs during the evaluation of any +** of these routines, a default value is returned. The default value +** is either the integer 0, the floating point number 0.0, or a NULL +** pointer. Subsequent calls to [sqlite3_errcode()] will return +** [SQLITE_NOMEM]. +*/ +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_blob(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_bytes(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_bytes16(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API double sqlite3_column_double(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_int(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_column_int64(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API const unsigned char *sqlite3_column_text(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_column_text16(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_column_type(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); +SQLITE_API sqlite3_value *sqlite3_column_value(sqlite3_stmt*, int iCol); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Destroy A Prepared Statement Object {F13300} +** +** The sqlite3_finalize() function is called to delete a +** [sqlite3_stmt | compiled SQL statement]. If the statement was +** executed successfully, or not executed at all, then SQLITE_OK is returned. +** If execution of the statement failed then an +** [SQLITE_ERROR | error code] or [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended error code] +** is returned. +** +** This routine can be called at any point during the execution of the +** [sqlite3_stmt | virtual machine]. If the virtual machine has not +** completed execution when this routine is called, that is like +** encountering an error or an interrupt. (See [sqlite3_interrupt()].) +** Incomplete updates may be rolled back and transactions cancelled, +** depending on the circumstances, and the +** [SQLITE_ERROR | result code] returned will be [SQLITE_ABORT]. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_finalize(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Reset A Prepared Statement Object {F13330} +** +** The sqlite3_reset() function is called to reset a +** [sqlite3_stmt | compiled SQL statement] object. +** back to its initial state, ready to be re-executed. +** Any SQL statement variables that had values bound to them using +** the [sqlite3_bind_blob | sqlite3_bind_*() API] retain their values. +** Use [sqlite3_clear_bindings()] to reset the bindings. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_reset(sqlite3_stmt *pStmt); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Create Or Redefine SQL Functions {F16100} +** +** The following two functions are used to add SQL functions or aggregates +** or to redefine the behavior of existing SQL functions or aggregates. The +** difference only between the two is that the second parameter, the +** name of the (scalar) function or aggregate, is encoded in UTF-8 for +** sqlite3_create_function() and UTF-16 for sqlite3_create_function16(). +** +** The first argument is the [sqlite3 | database handle] that holds the +** SQL function or aggregate is to be added or redefined. If a single +** program uses more than one database handle internally, then SQL +** functions or aggregates must be added individually to each database +** handle with which they will be used. +** +** The second parameter is the name of the SQL function to be created +** or redefined. +** The length of the name is limited to 255 bytes, exclusive of the +** zero-terminator. Note that the name length limit is in bytes, not +** characters. Any attempt to create a function with a longer name +** will result in an SQLITE_ERROR error. +** +** The third parameter is the number of arguments that the SQL function or +** aggregate takes. If this parameter is negative, then the SQL function or +** aggregate may take any number of arguments. +** +** The fourth parameter, eTextRep, specifies what +** [SQLITE_UTF8 | text encoding] this SQL function prefers for +** its parameters. Any SQL function implementation should be able to work +** work with UTF-8, UTF-16le, or UTF-16be. But some implementations may be +** more efficient with one encoding than another. It is allowed to +** invoke sqlite3_create_function() or sqlite3_create_function16() multiple +** times with the same function but with different values of eTextRep. +** When multiple implementations of the same function are available, SQLite +** will pick the one that involves the least amount of data conversion. +** If there is only a single implementation which does not care what +** text encoding is used, then the fourth argument should be +** [SQLITE_ANY]. +** +** The fifth parameter is an arbitrary pointer. The implementation +** of the function can gain access to this pointer using +** [sqlite3_user_data()]. +** +** The seventh, eighth and ninth parameters, xFunc, xStep and xFinal, are +** pointers to C-language functions that implement the SQL +** function or aggregate. A scalar SQL function requires an implementation of +** the xFunc callback only, NULL pointers should be passed as the xStep +** and xFinal parameters. An aggregate SQL function requires an implementation +** of xStep and xFinal and NULL should be passed for xFunc. To delete an +** existing SQL function or aggregate, pass NULL for all three function +** callback. +** +** It is permitted to register multiple implementations of the same +** functions with the same name but with either differing numbers of +** arguments or differing perferred text encodings. SQLite will use +** the implementation most closely matches the way in which the +** SQL function is used. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_function( + sqlite3 *, + const char *zFunctionName, + int nArg, + int eTextRep, + void*, + void (*xFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**), + void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**), + void (*xFinal)(sqlite3_context*) +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_function16( + sqlite3*, + const void *zFunctionName, + int nArg, + int eTextRep, + void*, + void (*xFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**), + void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**), + void (*xFinal)(sqlite3_context*) +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Text Encodings {F10267} +** +** These constant define integer codes that represent the various +** text encodings supported by SQLite. +*/ +#define SQLITE_UTF8 1 +#define SQLITE_UTF16LE 2 +#define SQLITE_UTF16BE 3 +#define SQLITE_UTF16 4 /* Use native byte order */ +#define SQLITE_ANY 5 /* sqlite3_create_function only */ +#define SQLITE_UTF16_ALIGNED 8 /* sqlite3_create_collation only */ + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Obsolete Functions +** +** These functions are all now obsolete. In order to maintain +** backwards compatibility with older code, we continue to support +** these functions. However, new development projects should avoid +** the use of these functions. To help encourage people to avoid +** using these functions, we are not going to tell you want they do. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_aggregate_count(sqlite3_context*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_expired(sqlite3_stmt*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_transfer_bindings(sqlite3_stmt*, sqlite3_stmt*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_global_recover(void); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_thread_cleanup(void); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_memory_alarm(void(*)(void*,sqlite3_int64,int),void*,sqlite3_int64); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Obtaining SQL Function Parameter Values {F15100} +** +** The C-language implementation of SQL functions and aggregates uses +** this set of interface routines to access the parameter values on +** the function or aggregate. +** +** The xFunc (for scalar functions) or xStep (for aggregates) parameters +** to [sqlite3_create_function()] and [sqlite3_create_function16()] +** define callbacks that implement the SQL functions and aggregates. +** The 4th parameter to these callbacks is an array of pointers to +** [sqlite3_value] objects. There is one [sqlite3_value] object for +** each parameter to the SQL function. These routines are used to +** extract values from the [sqlite3_value] objects. +** +** These routines work just like the corresponding +** [sqlite3_column_blob | sqlite3_column_* routines] except that +** these routines take a single [sqlite3_value*] pointer instead +** of an [sqlite3_stmt*] pointer and an integer column number. +** +** The sqlite3_value_text16() interface extracts a UTF16 string +** in the native byte-order of the host machine. The +** sqlite3_value_text16be() and sqlite3_value_text16le() interfaces +** extract UTF16 strings as big-endian and little-endian respectively. +** +** The sqlite3_value_numeric_type() interface attempts to apply +** numeric affinity to the value. This means that an attempt is +** made to convert the value to an integer or floating point. If +** such a conversion is possible without loss of information (in other +** words if the value is a string that looks like a number) +** then the conversion is done. Otherwise no conversion occurs. The +** [SQLITE_INTEGER | datatype] after conversion is returned. +** +** Please pay particular attention to the fact that the pointer that +** is returned from [sqlite3_value_blob()], [sqlite3_value_text()], or +** [sqlite3_value_text16()] can be invalidated by a subsequent call to +** [sqlite3_value_bytes()], [sqlite3_value_bytes16()], [sqlite3_value_text()], +** or [sqlite3_value_text16()]. +** +** These routines must be called from the same thread as +** the SQL function that supplied the sqlite3_value* parameters. +** Or, if the sqlite3_value* argument comes from the [sqlite3_column_value()] +** interface, then these routines should be called from the same thread +** that ran [sqlite3_column_value()]. +** +*/ +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_blob(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_bytes(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_bytes16(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API double sqlite3_value_double(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_int(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API sqlite3_int64 sqlite3_value_int64(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API const unsigned char *sqlite3_value_text(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_text16(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_text16le(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API const void *sqlite3_value_text16be(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_type(sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_value_numeric_type(sqlite3_value*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Obtain Aggregate Function Context {F16210} +** +** The implementation of aggregate SQL functions use this routine to allocate +** a structure for storing their state. +** {F16211} The first time the sqlite3_aggregate_context() routine is +** is called for a particular aggregate, SQLite allocates nBytes of memory +** zeros that memory, and returns a pointer to it. +** {F16212} On second and subsequent calls to sqlite3_aggregate_context() +** for the same aggregate function index, the same buffer is returned. {END} +** The implementation +** of the aggregate can use the returned buffer to accumulate data. +** +** {F16213} SQLite automatically frees the allocated buffer when the aggregate +** query concludes. {END} +** +** The first parameter should be a copy of the +** [sqlite3_context | SQL function context] that is the first +** parameter to the callback routine that implements the aggregate +** function. +** +** This routine must be called from the same thread in which +** the aggregate SQL function is running. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_aggregate_context(sqlite3_context*, int nBytes); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: User Data For Functions {F16240} +** +** {F16241} The sqlite3_user_data() interface returns a copy of +** the pointer that was the pUserData parameter (the 5th parameter) +** of the the [sqlite3_create_function()] +** and [sqlite3_create_function16()] routines that originally +** registered the application defined function. {END} +** +** {U16243} This routine must be called from the same thread in which +** the application-defined function is running. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_user_data(sqlite3_context*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Function Auxiliary Data {F16270} +** +** The following two functions may be used by scalar SQL functions to +** associate meta-data with argument values. If the same value is passed to +** multiple invocations of the same SQL function during query execution, under +** some circumstances the associated meta-data may be preserved. This may +** be used, for example, to add a regular-expression matching scalar +** function. The compiled version of the regular expression is stored as +** meta-data associated with the SQL value passed as the regular expression +** pattern. The compiled regular expression can be reused on multiple +** invocations of the same function so that the original pattern string +** does not need to be recompiled on each invocation. +** +** {F16271} +** The sqlite3_get_auxdata() interface returns a pointer to the meta-data +** associated by the sqlite3_set_auxdata() function with the Nth argument +** value to the application-defined function. +** {F16272} If no meta-data has been ever been set for the Nth +** argument of the function, or if the cooresponding function parameter +** has changed since the meta-data was set, then sqlite3_get_auxdata() +** returns a NULL pointer. +** +** {F16275} The sqlite3_set_auxdata() interface saves the meta-data +** pointed to by its 3rd parameter as the meta-data for the N-th +** argument of the application-defined function. {END} Subsequent +** calls to sqlite3_get_auxdata() might return this data, if it has +** not been destroyed. +** {F16277} If it is not NULL, SQLite will invoke the destructor +** function given by the 4th parameter to sqlite3_set_auxdata() on +** the meta-data when the corresponding function parameter changes +** or when the SQL statement completes, whichever comes first. {END} +** +** In practice, meta-data is preserved between function calls for +** expressions that are constant at compile time. This includes literal +** values and SQL variables. +** +** These routines must be called from the same thread in which +** the SQL function is running. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_get_auxdata(sqlite3_context*, int N); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_set_auxdata(sqlite3_context*, int N, void*, void (*)(void*)); + + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Constants Defining Special Destructor Behavior {F10280} +** +** These are special value for the destructor that is passed in as the +** final argument to routines like [sqlite3_result_blob()]. If the destructor +** argument is SQLITE_STATIC, it means that the content pointer is constant +** and will never change. It does not need to be destroyed. The +** SQLITE_TRANSIENT value means that the content will likely change in +** the near future and that SQLite should make its own private copy of +** the content before returning. +** +** The typedef is necessary to work around problems in certain +** C++ compilers. See ticket #2191. +*/ +typedef void (*sqlite3_destructor_type)(void*); +#define SQLITE_STATIC ((sqlite3_destructor_type)0) +#define SQLITE_TRANSIENT ((sqlite3_destructor_type)-1) + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Setting The Result Of An SQL Function {F16400} +** +** These routines are used by the xFunc or xFinal callbacks that +** implement SQL functions and aggregates. See +** [sqlite3_create_function()] and [sqlite3_create_function16()] +** for additional information. +** +** These functions work very much like the +** [sqlite3_bind_blob | sqlite3_bind_*] family of functions used +** to bind values to host parameters in prepared statements. +** Refer to the +** [sqlite3_bind_blob | sqlite3_bind_* documentation] for +** additional information. +** +** {F16402} The sqlite3_result_blob() interface sets the result from +** an application defined function to be the BLOB whose content is pointed +** to by the second parameter and which is N bytes long where N is the +** third parameter. +** {F16403} The sqlite3_result_zeroblob() inerfaces set the result of +** the application defined function to be a BLOB containing all zero +** bytes and N bytes in size, where N is the value of the 2nd parameter. +** +** {F16407} The sqlite3_result_double() interface sets the result from +** an application defined function to be a floating point value specified +** by its 2nd argument. +** +** {F16409} The sqlite3_result_error() and sqlite3_result_error16() functions +** cause the implemented SQL function to throw an exception. +** {F16411} SQLite uses the string pointed to by the +** 2nd parameter of sqlite3_result_error() or sqlite3_result_error16() +** as the text of an error message. {F16412} SQLite interprets the error +** message string from sqlite3_result_error() as UTF8. {F16413} SQLite +** interprets the string from sqlite3_result_error16() as UTF16 in native +** byte order. {F16414} If the third parameter to sqlite3_result_error() +** or sqlite3_result_error16() is negative then SQLite takes as the error +** message all text up through the first zero character. +** {F16415} If the third parameter to sqlite3_result_error() or +** sqlite3_result_error16() is non-negative then SQLite takes that many +** bytes (not characters) from the 2nd parameter as the error message. +** {F16417} The sqlite3_result_error() and sqlite3_result_error16() +** routines make a copy private copy of the error message text before +** they return. {END} Hence, the calling function can deallocate or +** modify the text after they return without harm. +** +** {F16421} The sqlite3_result_toobig() interface causes SQLite +** to throw an error indicating that a string or BLOB is to long +** to represent. {F16422} The sqlite3_result_nomem() interface +** causes SQLite to throw an exception indicating that the a +** memory allocation failed. +** +** {F16431} The sqlite3_result_int() interface sets the return value +** of the application-defined function to be the 32-bit signed integer +** value given in the 2nd argument. +** {F16432} The sqlite3_result_int64() interface sets the return value +** of the application-defined function to be the 64-bit signed integer +** value given in the 2nd argument. +** +** {F16437} The sqlite3_result_null() interface sets the return value +** of the application-defined function to be NULL. +** +** {F16441} The sqlite3_result_text(), sqlite3_result_text16(), +** sqlite3_result_text16le(), and sqlite3_result_text16be() interfaces +** set the return value of the application-defined function to be +** a text string which is represented as UTF-8, UTF-16 native byte order, +** UTF-16 little endian, or UTF-16 big endian, respectively. +** {F16442} SQLite takes the text result from the application from +** the 2nd parameter of the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces. +** {F16444} If the 3rd parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces +** is negative, then SQLite takes result text from the 2nd parameter +** through the first zero character. +** {F16447} If the 3rd parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces +** is non-negative, then as many bytes (not characters) of the text +** pointed to by the 2nd parameter are taken as the application-defined +** function result. +** {F16451} If the 4th parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces +** or sqlite3_result_blob is a non-NULL pointer, then SQLite calls that +** function as the destructor on the text or blob result when it has +** finished using that result. +** {F16453} If the 4th parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces +** or sqlite3_result_blob is the special constant SQLITE_STATIC, then +** SQLite assumes that the text or blob result is constant space and +** does not copy the space or call a destructor when it has +** finished using that result. +** {F16454} If the 4th parameter to the sqlite3_result_text* interfaces +** or sqlite3_result_blob is the special constant SQLITE_TRANSIENT +** then SQLite makes a copy of the result into space obtained from +** from [sqlite3_malloc()] before it returns. +** +** {F16461} The sqlite3_result_value() interface sets the result of +** the application-defined function to be a copy the [sqlite3_value] +** object specified by the 2nd parameter. {F16463} The +** sqlite3_result_value() interface makes a copy of the [sqlite3_value] +** so that [sqlite3_value] specified in the parameter may change or +** be deallocated after sqlite3_result_value() returns without harm. +** +** {U16491} These routines are called from within the different thread +** than the one containing the application-defined function that recieved +** the [sqlite3_context] pointer, the results are undefined. +*/ +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_blob(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int, void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_double(sqlite3_context*, double); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error(sqlite3_context*, const char*, int); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error16(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error_toobig(sqlite3_context*); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_error_nomem(sqlite3_context*); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_int(sqlite3_context*, int); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_int64(sqlite3_context*, sqlite3_int64); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_null(sqlite3_context*); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text(sqlite3_context*, const char*, int, void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text16(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int, void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text16le(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int,void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_text16be(sqlite3_context*, const void*, int,void(*)(void*)); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_value(sqlite3_context*, sqlite3_value*); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_result_zeroblob(sqlite3_context*, int n); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Define New Collating Sequences {F16600} +** +** {F16601} +** These functions are used to add new collation sequences to the +** [sqlite3*] handle specified as the first argument. +** +** {F16602} +** The name of the new collation sequence is specified as a UTF-8 string +** for sqlite3_create_collation() and sqlite3_create_collation_v2() +** and a UTF-16 string for sqlite3_create_collation16(). {F16603} In all cases +** the name is passed as the second function argument. +** +** {F16604} +** The third argument may be one of the constants [SQLITE_UTF8], +** [SQLITE_UTF16LE] or [SQLITE_UTF16BE], indicating that the user-supplied +** routine expects to be passed pointers to strings encoded using UTF-8, +** UTF-16 little-endian or UTF-16 big-endian respectively. {F16605} The +** third argument might also be [SQLITE_UTF16_ALIGNED] to indicate that +** the routine expects pointers to 16-bit word aligned strings +** of UTF16 in the native byte order of the host computer. +** +** {F16607} +** A pointer to the user supplied routine must be passed as the fifth +** argument. {F16609} If it is NULL, this is the same as deleting the collation +** sequence (so that SQLite cannot call it anymore). +** {F16611} Each time the application +** supplied function is invoked, it is passed a copy of the void* passed as +** the fourth argument to sqlite3_create_collation() or +** sqlite3_create_collation16() as its first parameter. +** +** {F16612} +** The remaining arguments to the application-supplied routine are two strings, +** each represented by a [length, data] pair and encoded in the encoding +** that was passed as the third argument when the collation sequence was +** registered. {END} The application defined collation routine should +** return negative, zero or positive if +** the first string is less than, equal to, or greater than the second +** string. i.e. (STRING1 - STRING2). +** +** {F16615} +** The sqlite3_create_collation_v2() works like sqlite3_create_collation() +** excapt that it takes an extra argument which is a destructor for +** the collation. {F16617} The destructor is called when the collation is +** destroyed and is passed a copy of the fourth parameter void* pointer +** of the sqlite3_create_collation_v2(). +** {F16618} Collations are destroyed when +** they are overridden by later calls to the collation creation functions +** or when the [sqlite3*] database handle is closed using [sqlite3_close()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_collation( + sqlite3*, + const char *zName, + int eTextRep, + void*, + int(*xCompare)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*) +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_collation_v2( + sqlite3*, + const char *zName, + int eTextRep, + void*, + int(*xCompare)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*), + void(*xDestroy)(void*) +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_collation16( + sqlite3*, + const char *zName, + int eTextRep, + void*, + int(*xCompare)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*) +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Collation Needed Callbacks {F16700} +** +** {F16701} +** To avoid having to register all collation sequences before a database +** can be used, a single callback function may be registered with the +** database handle to be called whenever an undefined collation sequence is +** required. +** +** {F16702} +** If the function is registered using the sqlite3_collation_needed() API, +** then it is passed the names of undefined collation sequences as strings +** encoded in UTF-8. {F16703} If sqlite3_collation_needed16() is used, the names +** are passed as UTF-16 in machine native byte order. {F16704} A call to either +** function replaces any existing callback. +** +** {F16705} When the callback is invoked, the first argument passed is a copy +** of the second argument to sqlite3_collation_needed() or +** sqlite3_collation_needed16(). {F16706} The second argument is the database +** handle. {F16707} The third argument is one of [SQLITE_UTF8], +** [SQLITE_UTF16BE], or [SQLITE_UTF16LE], indicating the most +** desirable form of the collation sequence function required. +** {F16708} The fourth parameter is the name of the +** required collation sequence. {END} +** +** The callback function should register the desired collation using +** [sqlite3_create_collation()], [sqlite3_create_collation16()], or +** [sqlite3_create_collation_v2()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_collation_needed( + sqlite3*, + void*, + void(*)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const char*) +); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_collation_needed16( + sqlite3*, + void*, + void(*)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const void*) +); + +/* +** Specify the key for an encrypted database. This routine should be +** called right after sqlite3_open(). +** +** The code to implement this API is not available in the public release +** of SQLite. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_key( + sqlite3 *db, /* Database to be rekeyed */ + const void *pKey, int nKey /* The key */ +); + +/* +** Change the key on an open database. If the current database is not +** encrypted, this routine will encrypt it. If pNew==0 or nNew==0, the +** database is decrypted. +** +** The code to implement this API is not available in the public release +** of SQLite. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_rekey( + sqlite3 *db, /* Database to be rekeyed */ + const void *pKey, int nKey /* The new key */ +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Suspend Execution For A Short Time {F10530} +** +** {F10531} The sqlite3_sleep() function +** causes the current thread to suspend execution +** for at least a number of milliseconds specified in its parameter. +** +** {F10532} If the operating system does not support sleep requests with +** millisecond time resolution, then the time will be rounded up to +** the nearest second. {F10533} The number of milliseconds of sleep actually +** requested from the operating system is returned. +** +** {F10534} SQLite implements this interface by calling the xSleep() +** method of the default [sqlite3_vfs] object. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_sleep(int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Name Of The Folder Holding Temporary Files {F10310} +** +** If this global variable is made to point to a string which is +** the name of a folder (a.ka. directory), then all temporary files +** created by SQLite will be placed in that directory. If this variable +** is NULL pointer, then SQLite does a search for an appropriate temporary +** file directory. +** +** It is not safe to modify this variable once a database connection +** has been opened. It is intended that this variable be set once +** as part of process initialization and before any SQLite interface +** routines have been call and remain unchanged thereafter. +*/ +SQLITE_EXTERN char *sqlite3_temp_directory; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Test To See If The Database Is In Auto-Commit Mode {F12930} +** +** {F12931} The sqlite3_get_autocommit() interfaces returns non-zero or +** zero if the given database connection is or is not in autocommit mode, +** respectively. {F12932} Autocommit mode is on +** by default. {F12933} Autocommit mode is disabled by a BEGIN statement. +** {F12934} Autocommit mode is reenabled by a COMMIT or ROLLBACK. {END} +** +** If certain kinds of errors occur on a statement within a multi-statement +** transactions (errors including [SQLITE_FULL], [SQLITE_IOERR], +** [SQLITE_NOMEM], [SQLITE_BUSY], and [SQLITE_INTERRUPT]) then the +** transaction might be rolled back automatically. {F12935} The only way to +** find out if SQLite automatically rolled back the transaction after +** an error is to use this function. {END} +** +** {U12936} If another thread changes the autocommit status of the database +** connection while this routine is running, then the return value +** is undefined. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_get_autocommit(sqlite3*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Find The Database Handle Of A Prepared Statement {F13120} +** +** {F13121} The sqlite3_db_handle interface +** returns the [sqlite3*] database handle to which a +** [sqlite3_stmt | prepared statement] belongs. +** {F13122} the database handle returned by sqlite3_db_handle +** is the same database handle that was +** the first argument to the [sqlite3_prepare_v2()] or its variants +** that was used to create the statement in the first place. +*/ +SQLITE_API sqlite3 *sqlite3_db_handle(sqlite3_stmt*); + + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Commit And Rollback Notification Callbacks {F12950} +** +** {F12951} The sqlite3_commit_hook() interface registers a callback +** function to be invoked whenever a transaction is committed. +** {F12952} Any callback set by a previous call to sqlite3_commit_hook() +** for the same database connection is overridden. +** {F12953} The sqlite3_rollback_hook() interface registers a callback +** function to be invoked whenever a transaction is committed. +** {F12954} Any callback set by a previous call to sqlite3_commit_hook() +** for the same database connection is overridden. +** {F12956} The pArg argument is passed through +** to the callback. {F12957} If the callback on a commit hook function +** returns non-zero, then the commit is converted into a rollback. +** +** {F12958} If another function was previously registered, its +** pArg value is returned. Otherwise NULL is returned. +** +** {F12959} Registering a NULL function disables the callback. +** +** {F12961} For the purposes of this API, a transaction is said to have been +** rolled back if an explicit "ROLLBACK" statement is executed, or +** an error or constraint causes an implicit rollback to occur. +** {F12962} The rollback callback is not invoked if a transaction is +** automatically rolled back because the database connection is closed. +** {F12964} The rollback callback is not invoked if a transaction is +** rolled back because a commit callback returned non-zero. +** Check on this {END} +** +** These are experimental interfaces and are subject to change. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_commit_hook(sqlite3*, int(*)(void*), void*); +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_rollback_hook(sqlite3*, void(*)(void *), void*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Data Change Notification Callbacks {F12970} +** +** {F12971} The sqlite3_update_hook() interface +** registers a callback function with the database connection identified by the +** first argument to be invoked whenever a row is updated, inserted or deleted. +** {F12972} Any callback set by a previous call to this function for the same +** database connection is overridden. +** +** {F12974} The second argument is a pointer to the function to invoke when a +** row is updated, inserted or deleted. +** {F12976} The first argument to the callback is +** a copy of the third argument to sqlite3_update_hook(). +** {F12977} The second callback +** argument is one of [SQLITE_INSERT], [SQLITE_DELETE] or [SQLITE_UPDATE], +** depending on the operation that caused the callback to be invoked. +** {F12978} The third and +** fourth arguments to the callback contain pointers to the database and +** table name containing the affected row. +** {F12979} The final callback parameter is +** the rowid of the row. +** {F12981} In the case of an update, this is the rowid after +** the update takes place. +** +** {F12983} The update hook is not invoked when internal system tables are +** modified (i.e. sqlite_master and sqlite_sequence). +** +** {F12984} If another function was previously registered, its pArg value +** is returned. {F12985} Otherwise NULL is returned. +*/ +SQLITE_API void *sqlite3_update_hook( + sqlite3*, + void(*)(void *,int ,char const *,char const *,sqlite3_int64), + void* +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable Shared Pager Cache {F10330} +** +** {F10331} +** This routine enables or disables the sharing of the database cache +** and schema data structures between connections to the same database. +** {F10332} +** Sharing is enabled if the argument is true and disabled if the argument +** is false. +** +** {F10333} Cache sharing is enabled and disabled +** for an entire process. {END} This is a change as of SQLite version 3.5.0. +** In prior versions of SQLite, sharing was +** enabled or disabled for each thread separately. +** +** {F10334} +** The cache sharing mode set by this interface effects all subsequent +** calls to [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open_v2()], and [sqlite3_open16()]. +** {F10335} Existing database connections continue use the sharing mode +** that was in effect at the time they were opened. {END} +** +** Virtual tables cannot be used with a shared cache. {F10336} When shared +** cache is enabled, the [sqlite3_create_module()] API used to register +** virtual tables will always return an error. {END} +** +** {F10337} This routine returns [SQLITE_OK] if shared cache was +** enabled or disabled successfully. {F10338} An [SQLITE_ERROR | error code] +** is returned otherwise. {END} +** +** {F10339} Shared cache is disabled by default. {END} But this might change in +** future releases of SQLite. Applications that care about shared +** cache setting should set it explicitly. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_enable_shared_cache(int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Attempt To Free Heap Memory {F17340} +** +** {F17341} The sqlite3_release_memory() interface attempts to +** free N bytes of heap memory by deallocating non-essential memory +** allocations held by the database labrary. {END} Memory used +** to cache database pages to improve performance is an example of +** non-essential memory. {F16342} sqlite3_release_memory() returns +** the number of bytes actually freed, which might be more or less +** than the amount requested. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_release_memory(int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Impose A Limit On Heap Size {F17350} +** +** {F16351} The sqlite3_soft_heap_limit() interface +** places a "soft" limit on the amount of heap memory that may be allocated +** by SQLite. {F16352} If an internal allocation is requested +** that would exceed the soft heap limit, [sqlite3_release_memory()] is +** invoked one or more times to free up some space before the allocation +** is made. {END} +** +** {F16353} The limit is called "soft", because if +** [sqlite3_release_memory()] cannot +** free sufficient memory to prevent the limit from being exceeded, +** the memory is allocated anyway and the current operation proceeds. +** +** {F16354} +** A negative or zero value for N means that there is no soft heap limit and +** [sqlite3_release_memory()] will only be called when memory is exhausted. +** {F16355} The default value for the soft heap limit is zero. +** +** SQLite makes a best effort to honor the soft heap limit. +** {F16356} But if the soft heap limit cannot honored, execution will +** continue without error or notification. {END} This is why the limit is +** called a "soft" limit. It is advisory only. +** +** Prior to SQLite version 3.5.0, this routine only constrained the memory +** allocated by a single thread - the same thread in which this routine +** runs. Beginning with SQLite version 3.5.0, the soft heap limit is +** applied to all threads. {F16357} The value specified for the soft heap limit +** is an upper bound on the total memory allocation for all threads. {END} In +** version 3.5.0 there is no mechanism for limiting the heap usage for +** individual threads. +*/ +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_soft_heap_limit(int); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Extract Metadata About A Column Of A Table {F12850} +** +** This routine +** returns meta-data about a specific column of a specific database +** table accessible using the connection handle passed as the first function +** argument. +** +** The column is identified by the second, third and fourth parameters to +** this function. The second parameter is either the name of the database +** (i.e. "main", "temp" or an attached database) containing the specified +** table or NULL. If it is NULL, then all attached databases are searched +** for the table using the same algorithm as the database engine uses to +** resolve unqualified table references. +** +** The third and fourth parameters to this function are the table and column +** name of the desired column, respectively. Neither of these parameters +** may be NULL. +** +** Meta information is returned by writing to the memory locations passed as +** the 5th and subsequent parameters to this function. Any of these +** arguments may be NULL, in which case the corresponding element of meta +** information is ommitted. +** +**
+** Parameter     Output Type      Description
+** -----------------------------------
+**
+**   5th         const char*      Data type
+**   6th         const char*      Name of the default collation sequence 
+**   7th         int              True if the column has a NOT NULL constraint
+**   8th         int              True if the column is part of the PRIMARY KEY
+**   9th         int              True if the column is AUTOINCREMENT
+** 
+** +** +** The memory pointed to by the character pointers returned for the +** declaration type and collation sequence is valid only until the next +** call to any sqlite API function. +** +** If the specified table is actually a view, then an error is returned. +** +** If the specified column is "rowid", "oid" or "_rowid_" and an +** INTEGER PRIMARY KEY column has been explicitly declared, then the output +** parameters are set for the explicitly declared column. If there is no +** explicitly declared IPK column, then the output parameters are set as +** follows: +** +**
+**     data type: "INTEGER"
+**     collation sequence: "BINARY"
+**     not null: 0
+**     primary key: 1
+**     auto increment: 0
+** 
+** +** This function may load one or more schemas from database files. If an +** error occurs during this process, or if the requested table or column +** cannot be found, an SQLITE error code is returned and an error message +** left in the database handle (to be retrieved using sqlite3_errmsg()). +** +** This API is only available if the library was compiled with the +** SQLITE_ENABLE_COLUMN_METADATA preprocessor symbol defined. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_table_column_metadata( + sqlite3 *db, /* Connection handle */ + const char *zDbName, /* Database name or NULL */ + const char *zTableName, /* Table name */ + const char *zColumnName, /* Column name */ + char const **pzDataType, /* OUTPUT: Declared data type */ + char const **pzCollSeq, /* OUTPUT: Collation sequence name */ + int *pNotNull, /* OUTPUT: True if NOT NULL constraint exists */ + int *pPrimaryKey, /* OUTPUT: True if column part of PK */ + int *pAutoinc /* OUTPUT: True if column is auto-increment */ +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Load An Extension {F12600} +** +** {F12601} The sqlite3_load_extension() interface +** attempts to load an SQLite extension library contained in the file +** zFile. {F12602} The entry point is zProc. {F12603} zProc may be 0 +** in which case the name of the entry point defaults +** to "sqlite3_extension_init". +** +** {F12604} The sqlite3_load_extension() interface shall +** return [SQLITE_OK] on success and [SQLITE_ERROR] if something goes wrong. +** +** {F12605} +** If an error occurs and pzErrMsg is not 0, then the +** sqlite3_load_extension() interface shall attempt to fill *pzErrMsg with +** error message text stored in memory obtained from [sqlite3_malloc()]. +** {END} The calling function should free this memory +** by calling [sqlite3_free()]. +** +** {F12606} +** Extension loading must be enabled using [sqlite3_enable_load_extension()] +** prior to calling this API or an error will be returned. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_load_extension( + sqlite3 *db, /* Load the extension into this database connection */ + const char *zFile, /* Name of the shared library containing extension */ + const char *zProc, /* Entry point. Derived from zFile if 0 */ + char **pzErrMsg /* Put error message here if not 0 */ +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Enable Or Disable Extension Loading {F12620} +** +** So as not to open security holes in older applications that are +** unprepared to deal with extension loading, and as a means of disabling +** extension loading while evaluating user-entered SQL, the following +** API is provided to turn the [sqlite3_load_extension()] mechanism on and +** off. {F12622} It is off by default. {END} See ticket #1863. +** +** {F12621} Call the sqlite3_enable_load_extension() routine +** with onoff==1 to turn extension loading on +** and call it with onoff==0 to turn it back off again. {END} +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_enable_load_extension(sqlite3 *db, int onoff); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Make Arrangements To Automatically Load An Extension {F12640} +** +** {F12641} This function +** registers an extension entry point that is automatically invoked +** whenever a new database connection is opened using +** [sqlite3_open()], [sqlite3_open16()], or [sqlite3_open_v2()]. {END} +** +** This API can be invoked at program startup in order to register +** one or more statically linked extensions that will be available +** to all new database connections. +** +** {F12642} Duplicate extensions are detected so calling this routine multiple +** times with the same extension is harmless. +** +** {F12643} This routine stores a pointer to the extension in an array +** that is obtained from sqlite_malloc(). {END} If you run a memory leak +** checker on your program and it reports a leak because of this +** array, then invoke [sqlite3_reset_auto_extension()] prior +** to shutdown to free the memory. +** +** {F12644} Automatic extensions apply across all threads. {END} +** +** This interface is experimental and is subject to change or +** removal in future releases of SQLite. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_auto_extension(void *xEntryPoint); + + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Reset Automatic Extension Loading {F12660} +** +** {F12661} This function disables all previously registered +** automatic extensions. {END} This +** routine undoes the effect of all prior [sqlite3_automatic_extension()] +** calls. +** +** {F12662} This call disabled automatic extensions in all threads. {END} +** +** This interface is experimental and is subject to change or +** removal in future releases of SQLite. +*/ +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_reset_auto_extension(void); + + +/* +****** EXPERIMENTAL - subject to change without notice ************** +** +** The interface to the virtual-table mechanism is currently considered +** to be experimental. The interface might change in incompatible ways. +** If this is a problem for you, do not use the interface at this time. +** +** When the virtual-table mechanism stablizes, we will declare the +** interface fixed, support it indefinitely, and remove this comment. +*/ + +/* +** Structures used by the virtual table interface +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_vtab sqlite3_vtab; +typedef struct sqlite3_index_info sqlite3_index_info; +typedef struct sqlite3_vtab_cursor sqlite3_vtab_cursor; +typedef struct sqlite3_module sqlite3_module; + +/* +** A module is a class of virtual tables. Each module is defined +** by an instance of the following structure. This structure consists +** mostly of methods for the module. +*/ +struct sqlite3_module { + int iVersion; + int (*xCreate)(sqlite3*, void *pAux, + int argc, const char *const*argv, + sqlite3_vtab **ppVTab, char**); + int (*xConnect)(sqlite3*, void *pAux, + int argc, const char *const*argv, + sqlite3_vtab **ppVTab, char**); + int (*xBestIndex)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, sqlite3_index_info*); + int (*xDisconnect)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab); + int (*xDestroy)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab); + int (*xOpen)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab, sqlite3_vtab_cursor **ppCursor); + int (*xClose)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*); + int (*xFilter)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*, int idxNum, const char *idxStr, + int argc, sqlite3_value **argv); + int (*xNext)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*); + int (*xEof)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*); + int (*xColumn)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*, sqlite3_context*, int); + int (*xRowid)(sqlite3_vtab_cursor*, sqlite3_int64 *pRowid); + int (*xUpdate)(sqlite3_vtab *, int, sqlite3_value **, sqlite3_int64 *); + int (*xBegin)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab); + int (*xSync)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab); + int (*xCommit)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab); + int (*xRollback)(sqlite3_vtab *pVTab); + int (*xFindFunction)(sqlite3_vtab *pVtab, int nArg, const char *zName, + void (**pxFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**), + void **ppArg); + + int (*xRename)(sqlite3_vtab *pVtab, const char *zNew); +}; + +/* +** The sqlite3_index_info structure and its substructures is used to +** pass information into and receive the reply from the xBestIndex +** method of an sqlite3_module. The fields under **Inputs** are the +** inputs to xBestIndex and are read-only. xBestIndex inserts its +** results into the **Outputs** fields. +** +** The aConstraint[] array records WHERE clause constraints of the +** form: +** +** column OP expr +** +** Where OP is =, <, <=, >, or >=. +** The particular operator is stored +** in aConstraint[].op. The index of the column is stored in +** aConstraint[].iColumn. aConstraint[].usable is TRUE if the +** expr on the right-hand side can be evaluated (and thus the constraint +** is usable) and false if it cannot. +** +** The optimizer automatically inverts terms of the form "expr OP column" +** and makes other simplifications to the WHERE clause in an attempt to +** get as many WHERE clause terms into the form shown above as possible. +** The aConstraint[] array only reports WHERE clause terms in the correct +** form that refer to the particular virtual table being queried. +** +** Information about the ORDER BY clause is stored in aOrderBy[]. +** Each term of aOrderBy records a column of the ORDER BY clause. +** +** The xBestIndex method must fill aConstraintUsage[] with information +** about what parameters to pass to xFilter. If argvIndex>0 then +** the right-hand side of the corresponding aConstraint[] is evaluated +** and becomes the argvIndex-th entry in argv. If aConstraintUsage[].omit +** is true, then the constraint is assumed to be fully handled by the +** virtual table and is not checked again by SQLite. +** +** The idxNum and idxPtr values are recorded and passed into xFilter. +** sqlite3_free() is used to free idxPtr if needToFreeIdxPtr is true. +** +** The orderByConsumed means that output from xFilter will occur in +** the correct order to satisfy the ORDER BY clause so that no separate +** sorting step is required. +** +** The estimatedCost value is an estimate of the cost of doing the +** particular lookup. A full scan of a table with N entries should have +** a cost of N. A binary search of a table of N entries should have a +** cost of approximately log(N). +*/ +struct sqlite3_index_info { + /* Inputs */ + int nConstraint; /* Number of entries in aConstraint */ + struct sqlite3_index_constraint { + int iColumn; /* Column on left-hand side of constraint */ + unsigned char op; /* Constraint operator */ + unsigned char usable; /* True if this constraint is usable */ + int iTermOffset; /* Used internally - xBestIndex should ignore */ + } *aConstraint; /* Table of WHERE clause constraints */ + int nOrderBy; /* Number of terms in the ORDER BY clause */ + struct sqlite3_index_orderby { + int iColumn; /* Column number */ + unsigned char desc; /* True for DESC. False for ASC. */ + } *aOrderBy; /* The ORDER BY clause */ + + /* Outputs */ + struct sqlite3_index_constraint_usage { + int argvIndex; /* if >0, constraint is part of argv to xFilter */ + unsigned char omit; /* Do not code a test for this constraint */ + } *aConstraintUsage; + int idxNum; /* Number used to identify the index */ + char *idxStr; /* String, possibly obtained from sqlite3_malloc */ + int needToFreeIdxStr; /* Free idxStr using sqlite3_free() if true */ + int orderByConsumed; /* True if output is already ordered */ + double estimatedCost; /* Estimated cost of using this index */ +}; +#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_EQ 2 +#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_GT 4 +#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_LE 8 +#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_LT 16 +#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_GE 32 +#define SQLITE_INDEX_CONSTRAINT_MATCH 64 + +/* +** This routine is used to register a new module name with an SQLite +** connection. Module names must be registered before creating new +** virtual tables on the module, or before using preexisting virtual +** tables of the module. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_module( + sqlite3 *db, /* SQLite connection to register module with */ + const char *zName, /* Name of the module */ + const sqlite3_module *, /* Methods for the module */ + void * /* Client data for xCreate/xConnect */ +); + +/* +** This routine is identical to the sqlite3_create_module() method above, +** except that it allows a destructor function to be specified. It is +** even more experimental than the rest of the virtual tables API. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_create_module_v2( + sqlite3 *db, /* SQLite connection to register module with */ + const char *zName, /* Name of the module */ + const sqlite3_module *, /* Methods for the module */ + void *, /* Client data for xCreate/xConnect */ + void(*xDestroy)(void*) /* Module destructor function */ +); + +/* +** Every module implementation uses a subclass of the following structure +** to describe a particular instance of the module. Each subclass will +** be tailored to the specific needs of the module implementation. The +** purpose of this superclass is to define certain fields that are common +** to all module implementations. +** +** Virtual tables methods can set an error message by assigning a +** string obtained from sqlite3_mprintf() to zErrMsg. The method should +** take care that any prior string is freed by a call to sqlite3_free() +** prior to assigning a new string to zErrMsg. After the error message +** is delivered up to the client application, the string will be automatically +** freed by sqlite3_free() and the zErrMsg field will be zeroed. Note +** that sqlite3_mprintf() and sqlite3_free() are used on the zErrMsg field +** since virtual tables are commonly implemented in loadable extensions which +** do not have access to sqlite3MPrintf() or sqlite3Free(). +*/ +struct sqlite3_vtab { + const sqlite3_module *pModule; /* The module for this virtual table */ + int nRef; /* Used internally */ + char *zErrMsg; /* Error message from sqlite3_mprintf() */ + /* Virtual table implementations will typically add additional fields */ +}; + +/* Every module implementation uses a subclass of the following structure +** to describe cursors that point into the virtual table and are used +** to loop through the virtual table. Cursors are created using the +** xOpen method of the module. Each module implementation will define +** the content of a cursor structure to suit its own needs. +** +** This superclass exists in order to define fields of the cursor that +** are common to all implementations. +*/ +struct sqlite3_vtab_cursor { + sqlite3_vtab *pVtab; /* Virtual table of this cursor */ + /* Virtual table implementations will typically add additional fields */ +}; + +/* +** The xCreate and xConnect methods of a module use the following API +** to declare the format (the names and datatypes of the columns) of +** the virtual tables they implement. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_declare_vtab(sqlite3*, const char *zCreateTable); + +/* +** Virtual tables can provide alternative implementations of functions +** using the xFindFunction method. But global versions of those functions +** must exist in order to be overloaded. +** +** This API makes sure a global version of a function with a particular +** name and number of parameters exists. If no such function exists +** before this API is called, a new function is created. The implementation +** of the new function always causes an exception to be thrown. So +** the new function is not good for anything by itself. Its only +** purpose is to be a place-holder function that can be overloaded +** by virtual tables. +** +** This API should be considered part of the virtual table interface, +** which is experimental and subject to change. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_overload_function(sqlite3*, const char *zFuncName, int nArg); + +/* +** The interface to the virtual-table mechanism defined above (back up +** to a comment remarkably similar to this one) is currently considered +** to be experimental. The interface might change in incompatible ways. +** If this is a problem for you, do not use the interface at this time. +** +** When the virtual-table mechanism stabilizes, we will declare the +** interface fixed, support it indefinitely, and remove this comment. +** +****** EXPERIMENTAL - subject to change without notice ************** +*/ + +/* +** CAPI3REF: A Handle To An Open BLOB {F17800} +** +** An instance of the following opaque structure is used to +** represent an blob-handle. A blob-handle is created by +** [sqlite3_blob_open()] and destroyed by [sqlite3_blob_close()]. +** The [sqlite3_blob_read()] and [sqlite3_blob_write()] interfaces +** can be used to read or write small subsections of the blob. +** The [sqlite3_blob_bytes()] interface returns the size of the +** blob in bytes. +*/ +typedef struct sqlite3_blob sqlite3_blob; + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Open A BLOB For Incremental I/O {F17810} +** +** {F17811} This interfaces opens a handle to the blob located +** in row iRow,, column zColumn, table zTable in database zDb; +** in other words, the same blob that would be selected by: +** +**
+**     SELECT zColumn FROM zDb.zTable WHERE rowid = iRow;
+** 
{END} +** +** {F17812} If the flags parameter is non-zero, the blob is opened for +** read and write access. If it is zero, the blob is opened for read +** access. {END} +** +** {F17813} On success, [SQLITE_OK] is returned and the new +** [sqlite3_blob | blob handle] is written to *ppBlob. +** {F17814} Otherwise an error code is returned and +** any value written to *ppBlob should not be used by the caller. +** {F17815} This function sets the database-handle error code and message +** accessible via [sqlite3_errcode()] and [sqlite3_errmsg()]. +** We should go through and mark all interfaces that behave this +** way with a similar statement +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_open( + sqlite3*, + const char *zDb, + const char *zTable, + const char *zColumn, + sqlite3_int64 iRow, + int flags, + sqlite3_blob **ppBlob +); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Close A BLOB Handle {F17830} +** +** Close an open [sqlite3_blob | blob handle]. +** +** {F17831} Closing a BLOB shall cause the current transaction to commit +** if there are no other BLOBs, no pending prepared statements, and the +** database connection is in autocommit mode. +** {F17832} If any writes were made to the BLOB, they might be held in cache +** until the close operation if they will fit. {END} +** Closing the BLOB often forces the changes +** out to disk and so if any I/O errors occur, they will likely occur +** at the time when the BLOB is closed. {F17833} Any errors that occur during +** closing are reported as a non-zero return value. +** +** {F17839} The BLOB is closed unconditionally. Even if this routine returns +** an error code, the BLOB is still closed. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_close(sqlite3_blob *); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Return The Size Of An Open BLOB {F17805} +** +** {F16806} Return the size in bytes of the blob accessible via the open +** [sqlite3_blob | blob-handle] passed as an argument. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_bytes(sqlite3_blob *); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Read Data From A BLOB Incrementally {F17850} +** +** This function is used to read data from an open +** [sqlite3_blob | blob-handle] into a caller supplied buffer. +** {F17851} n bytes of data are copied into buffer +** z from the open blob, starting at offset iOffset. +** +** {F17852} If offset iOffset is less than n bytes from the end of the blob, +** [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is read. {F17853} If n is +** less than zero [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is read. +** +** {F17854} On success, SQLITE_OK is returned. Otherwise, an +** [SQLITE_ERROR | SQLite error code] or an +** [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended error code] is returned. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_read(sqlite3_blob *, void *z, int n, int iOffset); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Write Data Into A BLOB Incrementally {F17870} +** +** This function is used to write data into an open +** [sqlite3_blob | blob-handle] from a user supplied buffer. +** {F17871} n bytes of data are copied from the buffer +** pointed to by z into the open blob, starting at offset iOffset. +** +** {F17872} If the [sqlite3_blob | blob-handle] passed as the first argument +** was not opened for writing (the flags parameter to [sqlite3_blob_open()] +*** was zero), this function returns [SQLITE_READONLY]. +** +** {F17873} This function may only modify the contents of the blob; it is +** not possible to increase the size of a blob using this API. +** {F17874} If offset iOffset is less than n bytes from the end of the blob, +** [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is written. {F17875} If n is +** less than zero [SQLITE_ERROR] is returned and no data is written. +** +** {F17876} On success, SQLITE_OK is returned. Otherwise, an +** [SQLITE_ERROR | SQLite error code] or an +** [SQLITE_IOERR_READ | extended error code] is returned. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_blob_write(sqlite3_blob *, const void *z, int n, int iOffset); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Virtual File System Objects {F11200} +** +** A virtual filesystem (VFS) is an [sqlite3_vfs] object +** that SQLite uses to interact +** with the underlying operating system. Most builds come with a +** single default VFS that is appropriate for the host computer. +** New VFSes can be registered and existing VFSes can be unregistered. +** The following interfaces are provided. +** +** {F11201} The sqlite3_vfs_find() interface returns a pointer to +** a VFS given its name. {F11202} Names are case sensitive. +** {F11203} Names are zero-terminated UTF-8 strings. +** {F11204} If there is no match, a NULL +** pointer is returned. {F11205} If zVfsName is NULL then the default +** VFS is returned. {END} +** +** {F11210} New VFSes are registered with sqlite3_vfs_register(). +** {F11211} Each new VFS becomes the default VFS if the makeDflt flag is set. +** {F11212} The same VFS can be registered multiple times without injury. +** {F11213} To make an existing VFS into the default VFS, register it again +** with the makeDflt flag set. {U11214} If two different VFSes with the +** same name are registered, the behavior is undefined. {U11215} If a +** VFS is registered with a name that is NULL or an empty string, +** then the behavior is undefined. +** +** {F11220} Unregister a VFS with the sqlite3_vfs_unregister() interface. +** {F11221} If the default VFS is unregistered, another VFS is chosen as +** the default. The choice for the new VFS is arbitrary. +*/ +SQLITE_API sqlite3_vfs *sqlite3_vfs_find(const char *zVfsName); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vfs_register(sqlite3_vfs*, int makeDflt); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_vfs_unregister(sqlite3_vfs*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Mutexes {F17000} +** +** The SQLite core uses these routines for thread +** synchronization. Though they are intended for internal +** use by SQLite, code that links against SQLite is +** permitted to use any of these routines. +** +** The SQLite source code contains multiple implementations +** of these mutex routines. An appropriate implementation +** is selected automatically at compile-time. The following +** implementations are available in the SQLite core: +** +**
    +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_OS2 +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREAD +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP +**
+** +** The SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP implementation is a set of routines +** that does no real locking and is appropriate for use in +** a single-threaded application. The SQLITE_MUTEX_OS2, +** SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREAD, and SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 implementations +** are appropriate for use on os/2, unix, and windows. +** +** If SQLite is compiled with the SQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF preprocessor +** macro defined (with "-DSQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF=1"), then no mutex +** implementation is included with the library. The +** mutex interface routines defined here become external +** references in the SQLite library for which implementations +** must be provided by the application. This facility allows an +** application that links against SQLite to provide its own mutex +** implementation without having to modify the SQLite core. +** +** {F17011} The sqlite3_mutex_alloc() routine allocates a new +** mutex and returns a pointer to it. {F17012} If it returns NULL +** that means that a mutex could not be allocated. {F17013} SQLite +** will unwind its stack and return an error. {F17014} The argument +** to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() is one of these integer constants: +** +**
    +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM2 +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG +**
  • SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU +**
{END} +** +** {F17015} The first two constants cause sqlite3_mutex_alloc() to create +** a new mutex. The new mutex is recursive when SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE +** is used but not necessarily so when SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST is used. {END} +** The mutex implementation does not need to make a distinction +** between SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE and SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST if it does +** not want to. {F17016} But SQLite will only request a recursive mutex in +** cases where it really needs one. {END} If a faster non-recursive mutex +** implementation is available on the host platform, the mutex subsystem +** might return such a mutex in response to SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST. +** +** {F17017} The other allowed parameters to sqlite3_mutex_alloc() each return +** a pointer to a static preexisting mutex. {END} Four static mutexes are +** used by the current version of SQLite. Future versions of SQLite +** may add additional static mutexes. Static mutexes are for internal +** use by SQLite only. Applications that use SQLite mutexes should +** use only the dynamic mutexes returned by SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST or +** SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE. +** +** {F17018} Note that if one of the dynamic mutex parameters (SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST +** or SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE) is used then sqlite3_mutex_alloc() +** returns a different mutex on every call. {F17034} But for the static +** mutex types, the same mutex is returned on every call that has +** the same type number. {END} +** +** {F17019} The sqlite3_mutex_free() routine deallocates a previously +** allocated dynamic mutex. {F17020} SQLite is careful to deallocate every +** dynamic mutex that it allocates. {U17021} The dynamic mutexes must not be in +** use when they are deallocated. {U17022} Attempting to deallocate a static +** mutex results in undefined behavior. {F17023} SQLite never deallocates +** a static mutex. {END} +** +** The sqlite3_mutex_enter() and sqlite3_mutex_try() routines attempt +** to enter a mutex. {F17024} If another thread is already within the mutex, +** sqlite3_mutex_enter() will block and sqlite3_mutex_try() will return +** SQLITE_BUSY. {F17025} The sqlite3_mutex_try() interface returns SQLITE_OK +** upon successful entry. {F17026} Mutexes created using +** SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE can be entered multiple times by the same thread. +** {F17027} In such cases the, +** mutex must be exited an equal number of times before another thread +** can enter. {U17028} If the same thread tries to enter any other +** kind of mutex more than once, the behavior is undefined. +** {F17029} SQLite will never exhibit +** such behavior in its own use of mutexes. {END} +** +** Some systems (ex: windows95) do not the operation implemented by +** sqlite3_mutex_try(). On those systems, sqlite3_mutex_try() will +** always return SQLITE_BUSY. {F17030} The SQLite core only ever uses +** sqlite3_mutex_try() as an optimization so this is acceptable behavior. {END} +** +** {F17031} The sqlite3_mutex_leave() routine exits a mutex that was +** previously entered by the same thread. {U17032} The behavior +** is undefined if the mutex is not currently entered by the +** calling thread or is not currently allocated. {F17033} SQLite will +** never do either. {END} +** +** See also: [sqlite3_mutex_held()] and [sqlite3_mutex_notheld()]. +*/ +SQLITE_API sqlite3_mutex *sqlite3_mutex_alloc(int); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_free(sqlite3_mutex*); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_enter(sqlite3_mutex*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_try(sqlite3_mutex*); +SQLITE_API void sqlite3_mutex_leave(sqlite3_mutex*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Mutex Verifcation Routines {F17080} +** +** The sqlite3_mutex_held() and sqlite3_mutex_notheld() routines +** are intended for use inside assert() statements. {F17081} The SQLite core +** never uses these routines except inside an assert() and applications +** are advised to follow the lead of the core. {F17082} The core only +** provides implementations for these routines when it is compiled +** with the SQLITE_DEBUG flag. {U17087} External mutex implementations +** are only required to provide these routines if SQLITE_DEBUG is +** defined and if NDEBUG is not defined. +** +** {F17083} These routines should return true if the mutex in their argument +** is held or not held, respectively, by the calling thread. {END} +** +** {X17084} The implementation is not required to provided versions of these +** routines that actually work. +** If the implementation does not provide working +** versions of these routines, it should at least provide stubs +** that always return true so that one does not get spurious +** assertion failures. {END} +** +** {F17085} If the argument to sqlite3_mutex_held() is a NULL pointer then +** the routine should return 1. {END} This seems counter-intuitive since +** clearly the mutex cannot be held if it does not exist. But the +** the reason the mutex does not exist is because the build is not +** using mutexes. And we do not want the assert() containing the +** call to sqlite3_mutex_held() to fail, so a non-zero return is +** the appropriate thing to do. {F17086} The sqlite3_mutex_notheld() +** interface should also return 1 when given a NULL pointer. +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_held(sqlite3_mutex*); +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_mutex_notheld(sqlite3_mutex*); + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Mutex Types {F17001} +** +** {F17002} The [sqlite3_mutex_alloc()] interface takes a single argument +** which is one of these integer constants. {END} +*/ +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_FAST 0 +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_RECURSIVE 1 +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MASTER 2 +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM 3 /* sqlite3_malloc() */ +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_MEM2 4 /* sqlite3_release_memory() */ +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_PRNG 5 /* sqlite3_random() */ +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_STATIC_LRU 6 /* lru page list */ + +/* +** CAPI3REF: Low-Level Control Of Database Files {F11300} +** +** {F11301} The [sqlite3_file_control()] interface makes a direct call to the +** xFileControl method for the [sqlite3_io_methods] object associated +** with a particular database identified by the second argument. {F11302} The +** name of the database is the name assigned to the database by the +** ATTACH SQL command that opened the +** database. {F11303} To control the main database file, use the name "main" +** or a NULL pointer. {F11304} The third and fourth parameters to this routine +** are passed directly through to the second and third parameters of +** the xFileControl method. {F11305} The return value of the xFileControl +** method becomes the return value of this routine. +** +** {F11306} If the second parameter (zDbName) does not match the name of any +** open database file, then SQLITE_ERROR is returned. {F11307} This error +** code is not remembered and will not be recalled by [sqlite3_errcode()] +** or [sqlite3_errmsg()]. {U11308} The underlying xFileControl method might +** also return SQLITE_ERROR. {U11309} There is no way to distinguish between +** an incorrect zDbName and an SQLITE_ERROR return from the underlying +** xFileControl method. {END} +** +** See also: [SQLITE_FCNTL_LOCKSTATE] +*/ +SQLITE_API int sqlite3_file_control(sqlite3*, const char *zDbName, int op, void*); + +/* +** Undo the hack that converts floating point types to integer for +** builds on processors without floating point support. +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT +# undef double +#endif + +#if 0 +} /* End of the 'extern "C"' block */ +#endif +#endif + +/************** End of sqlite3.h *********************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Include hash.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Begin file hash.h ********************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 22 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** This is the header file for the generic hash-table implemenation +** used in SQLite. +** +** $Id: hash.h,v 1.11 2007/09/04 14:31:47 danielk1977 Exp $ +*/ +#ifndef _SQLITE_HASH_H_ +#define _SQLITE_HASH_H_ + +/* Forward declarations of structures. */ +typedef struct Hash Hash; +typedef struct HashElem HashElem; + +/* A complete hash table is an instance of the following structure. +** The internals of this structure are intended to be opaque -- client +** code should not attempt to access or modify the fields of this structure +** directly. Change this structure only by using the routines below. +** However, many of the "procedures" and "functions" for modifying and +** accessing this structure are really macros, so we can't really make +** this structure opaque. +*/ +struct Hash { + char keyClass; /* SQLITE_HASH_INT, _POINTER, _STRING, _BINARY */ + char copyKey; /* True if copy of key made on insert */ + int count; /* Number of entries in this table */ + int htsize; /* Number of buckets in the hash table */ + HashElem *first; /* The first element of the array */ + struct _ht { /* the hash table */ + int count; /* Number of entries with this hash */ + HashElem *chain; /* Pointer to first entry with this hash */ + } *ht; +}; + +/* Each element in the hash table is an instance of the following +** structure. All elements are stored on a single doubly-linked list. +** +** Again, this structure is intended to be opaque, but it can't really +** be opaque because it is used by macros. +*/ +struct HashElem { + HashElem *next, *prev; /* Next and previous elements in the table */ + void *data; /* Data associated with this element */ + void *pKey; int nKey; /* Key associated with this element */ +}; + +/* +** There are 4 different modes of operation for a hash table: +** +** SQLITE_HASH_INT nKey is used as the key and pKey is ignored. +** +** SQLITE_HASH_POINTER pKey is used as the key and nKey is ignored. +** +** SQLITE_HASH_STRING pKey points to a string that is nKey bytes long +** (including the null-terminator, if any). Case +** is ignored in comparisons. +** +** SQLITE_HASH_BINARY pKey points to binary data nKey bytes long. +** memcmp() is used to compare keys. +** +** A copy of the key is made for SQLITE_HASH_STRING and SQLITE_HASH_BINARY +** if the copyKey parameter to HashInit is 1. +*/ +/* #define SQLITE_HASH_INT 1 // NOT USED */ +/* #define SQLITE_HASH_POINTER 2 // NOT USED */ +#define SQLITE_HASH_STRING 3 +#define SQLITE_HASH_BINARY 4 + +/* +** Access routines. To delete, insert a NULL pointer. +*/ +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HashInit(Hash*, int keytype, int copyKey); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HashInsert(Hash*, const void *pKey, int nKey, void *pData); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3HashFind(const Hash*, const void *pKey, int nKey); +SQLITE_PRIVATE HashElem *sqlite3HashFindElem(const Hash*, const void *pKey, int nKey); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3HashClear(Hash*); + +/* +** Macros for looping over all elements of a hash table. The idiom is +** like this: +** +** Hash h; +** HashElem *p; +** ... +** for(p=sqliteHashFirst(&h); p; p=sqliteHashNext(p)){ +** SomeStructure *pData = sqliteHashData(p); +** // do something with pData +** } +*/ +#define sqliteHashFirst(H) ((H)->first) +#define sqliteHashNext(E) ((E)->next) +#define sqliteHashData(E) ((E)->data) +#define sqliteHashKey(E) ((E)->pKey) +#define sqliteHashKeysize(E) ((E)->nKey) + +/* +** Number of entries in a hash table +*/ +#define sqliteHashCount(H) ((H)->count) + +#endif /* _SQLITE_HASH_H_ */ + +/************** End of hash.h ************************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Include parse.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/ +/************** Begin file parse.h *******************************************/ +#define TK_SEMI 1 +#define TK_EXPLAIN 2 +#define TK_QUERY 3 +#define TK_PLAN 4 +#define TK_BEGIN 5 +#define TK_TRANSACTION 6 +#define TK_DEFERRED 7 +#define TK_IMMEDIATE 8 +#define TK_EXCLUSIVE 9 +#define TK_COMMIT 10 +#define TK_END 11 +#define TK_ROLLBACK 12 +#define TK_CREATE 13 +#define TK_TABLE 14 +#define TK_IF 15 +#define TK_NOT 16 +#define TK_EXISTS 17 +#define TK_TEMP 18 +#define TK_LP 19 +#define TK_RP 20 +#define TK_AS 21 +#define TK_COMMA 22 +#define TK_ID 23 +#define TK_ABORT 24 +#define TK_AFTER 25 +#define TK_ANALYZE 26 +#define TK_ASC 27 +#define TK_ATTACH 28 +#define TK_BEFORE 29 +#define TK_CASCADE 30 +#define TK_CAST 31 +#define TK_CONFLICT 32 +#define TK_DATABASE 33 +#define TK_DESC 34 +#define TK_DETACH 35 +#define TK_EACH 36 +#define TK_FAIL 37 +#define TK_FOR 38 +#define TK_IGNORE 39 +#define TK_INITIALLY 40 +#define TK_INSTEAD 41 +#define TK_LIKE_KW 42 +#define TK_MATCH 43 +#define TK_KEY 44 +#define TK_OF 45 +#define TK_OFFSET 46 +#define TK_PRAGMA 47 +#define TK_RAISE 48 +#define TK_REPLACE 49 +#define TK_RESTRICT 50 +#define TK_ROW 51 +#define TK_TRIGGER 52 +#define TK_VACUUM 53 +#define TK_VIEW 54 +#define TK_VIRTUAL 55 +#define TK_REINDEX 56 +#define TK_RENAME 57 +#define TK_CTIME_KW 58 +#define TK_ANY 59 +#define TK_OR 60 +#define TK_AND 61 +#define TK_IS 62 +#define TK_BETWEEN 63 +#define TK_IN 64 +#define TK_ISNULL 65 +#define TK_NOTNULL 66 +#define TK_NE 67 +#define TK_EQ 68 +#define TK_GT 69 +#define TK_LE 70 +#define TK_LT 71 +#define TK_GE 72 +#define TK_ESCAPE 73 +#define TK_BITAND 74 +#define TK_BITOR 75 +#define TK_LSHIFT 76 +#define TK_RSHIFT 77 +#define TK_PLUS 78 +#define TK_MINUS 79 +#define TK_STAR 80 +#define TK_SLASH 81 +#define TK_REM 82 +#define TK_CONCAT 83 +#define TK_COLLATE 84 +#define TK_UMINUS 85 +#define TK_UPLUS 86 +#define TK_BITNOT 87 +#define TK_STRING 88 +#define TK_JOIN_KW 89 +#define TK_CONSTRAINT 90 +#define TK_DEFAULT 91 +#define TK_NULL 92 +#define TK_PRIMARY 93 +#define TK_UNIQUE 94 +#define TK_CHECK 95 +#define TK_REFERENCES 96 +#define TK_AUTOINCR 97 +#define TK_ON 98 +#define TK_DELETE 99 +#define TK_UPDATE 100 +#define TK_INSERT 101 +#define TK_SET 102 +#define TK_DEFERRABLE 103 +#define TK_FOREIGN 104 +#define TK_DROP 105 +#define TK_UNION 106 +#define TK_ALL 107 +#define TK_EXCEPT 108 +#define TK_INTERSECT 109 +#define TK_SELECT 110 +#define TK_DISTINCT 111 +#define TK_DOT 112 +#define TK_FROM 113 +#define TK_JOIN 114 +#define TK_USING 115 +#define TK_ORDER 116 +#define TK_BY 117 +#define TK_GROUP 118 +#define TK_HAVING 119 +#define TK_LIMIT 120 +#define TK_WHERE 121 +#define TK_INTO 122 +#define TK_VALUES 123 +#define TK_INTEGER 124 +#define TK_FLOAT 125 +#define TK_BLOB 126 +#define TK_REGISTER 127 +#define TK_VARIABLE 128 +#define TK_CASE 129 +#define TK_WHEN 130 +#define TK_THEN 131 +#define TK_ELSE 132 +#define TK_INDEX 133 +#define TK_ALTER 134 +#define TK_TO 135 +#define TK_ADD 136 +#define TK_COLUMNKW 137 +#define TK_TO_TEXT 138 +#define TK_TO_BLOB 139 +#define TK_TO_NUMERIC 140 +#define TK_TO_INT 141 +#define TK_TO_REAL 142 +#define TK_END_OF_FILE 143 +#define TK_ILLEGAL 144 +#define TK_SPACE 145 +#define TK_UNCLOSED_STRING 146 +#define TK_COMMENT 147 +#define TK_FUNCTION 148 +#define TK_COLUMN 149 +#define TK_AGG_FUNCTION 150 +#define TK_AGG_COLUMN 151 +#define TK_CONST_FUNC 152 + +/************** End of parse.h ***********************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ +#include +#include +#include +#include +#include + +#define sqlite3_isnan(X) ((X)!=(X)) + +/* +** If compiling for a processor that lacks floating point support, +** substitute integer for floating-point +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_FLOATING_POINT +# define double sqlite_int64 +# define LONGDOUBLE_TYPE sqlite_int64 +# ifndef SQLITE_BIG_DBL +# define SQLITE_BIG_DBL (0x7fffffffffffffff) +# endif +# define SQLITE_OMIT_DATETIME_FUNCS 1 +# define SQLITE_OMIT_TRACE 1 +# undef SQLITE_MIXED_ENDIAN_64BIT_FLOAT +#endif +#ifndef SQLITE_BIG_DBL +# define SQLITE_BIG_DBL (1e99) +#endif + +/* +** OMIT_TEMPDB is set to 1 if SQLITE_OMIT_TEMPDB is defined, or 0 +** afterward. Having this macro allows us to cause the C compiler +** to omit code used by TEMP tables without messy #ifndef statements. +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_OMIT_TEMPDB +#define OMIT_TEMPDB 1 +#else +#define OMIT_TEMPDB 0 +#endif + +/* +** If the following macro is set to 1, then NULL values are considered +** distinct when determining whether or not two entries are the same +** in a UNIQUE index. This is the way PostgreSQL, Oracle, DB2, MySQL, +** OCELOT, and Firebird all work. The SQL92 spec explicitly says this +** is the way things are suppose to work. +** +** If the following macro is set to 0, the NULLs are indistinct for +** a UNIQUE index. In this mode, you can only have a single NULL entry +** for a column declared UNIQUE. This is the way Informix and SQL Server +** work. +*/ +#define NULL_DISTINCT_FOR_UNIQUE 1 + +/* +** The "file format" number is an integer that is incremented whenever +** the VDBE-level file format changes. The following macros define the +** the default file format for new databases and the maximum file format +** that the library can read. +*/ +#define SQLITE_MAX_FILE_FORMAT 4 +#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT +# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_FILE_FORMAT 1 +#endif + +/* +** Provide a default value for TEMP_STORE in case it is not specified +** on the command-line +*/ +#ifndef TEMP_STORE +# define TEMP_STORE 1 +#endif + +/* +** GCC does not define the offsetof() macro so we'll have to do it +** ourselves. +*/ +#ifndef offsetof +#define offsetof(STRUCTURE,FIELD) ((int)((char*)&((STRUCTURE*)0)->FIELD)) +#endif + +/* +** Check to see if this machine uses EBCDIC. (Yes, believe it or +** not, there are still machines out there that use EBCDIC.) +*/ +#if 'A' == '\301' +# define SQLITE_EBCDIC 1 +#else +# define SQLITE_ASCII 1 +#endif + +/* +** Integers of known sizes. These typedefs might change for architectures +** where the sizes very. Preprocessor macros are available so that the +** types can be conveniently redefined at compile-type. Like this: +** +** cc '-DUINTPTR_TYPE=long long int' ... +*/ +#ifndef UINT32_TYPE +# define UINT32_TYPE unsigned int +#endif +#ifndef UINT16_TYPE +# define UINT16_TYPE unsigned short int +#endif +#ifndef INT16_TYPE +# define INT16_TYPE short int +#endif +#ifndef UINT8_TYPE +# define UINT8_TYPE unsigned char +#endif +#ifndef INT8_TYPE +# define INT8_TYPE signed char +#endif +#ifndef LONGDOUBLE_TYPE +# define LONGDOUBLE_TYPE long double +#endif +typedef sqlite_int64 i64; /* 8-byte signed integer */ +typedef sqlite_uint64 u64; /* 8-byte unsigned integer */ +typedef UINT32_TYPE u32; /* 4-byte unsigned integer */ +typedef UINT16_TYPE u16; /* 2-byte unsigned integer */ +typedef INT16_TYPE i16; /* 2-byte signed integer */ +typedef UINT8_TYPE u8; /* 1-byte unsigned integer */ +typedef UINT8_TYPE i8; /* 1-byte signed integer */ + +/* +** Macros to determine whether the machine is big or little endian, +** evaluated at runtime. +*/ +#ifdef SQLITE_AMALGAMATION +SQLITE_PRIVATE const int sqlite3One; +#else +SQLITE_PRIVATE const int sqlite3one; +#endif +#if defined(i386) || defined(__i386__) || defined(_M_IX86) +# define SQLITE_BIGENDIAN 0 +# define SQLITE_LITTLEENDIAN 1 +# define SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE SQLITE_UTF16LE +#else +# define SQLITE_BIGENDIAN (*(char *)(&sqlite3one)==0) +# define SQLITE_LITTLEENDIAN (*(char *)(&sqlite3one)==1) +# define SQLITE_UTF16NATIVE (SQLITE_BIGENDIAN?SQLITE_UTF16BE:SQLITE_UTF16LE) +#endif + +/* +** An instance of the following structure is used to store the busy-handler +** callback for a given sqlite handle. +** +** The sqlite.busyHandler member of the sqlite struct contains the busy +** callback for the database handle. Each pager opened via the sqlite +** handle is passed a pointer to sqlite.busyHandler. The busy-handler +** callback is currently invoked only from within pager.c. +*/ +typedef struct BusyHandler BusyHandler; +struct BusyHandler { + int (*xFunc)(void *,int); /* The busy callback */ + void *pArg; /* First arg to busy callback */ + int nBusy; /* Incremented with each busy call */ +}; + +/* +** Defer sourcing vdbe.h and btree.h until after the "u8" and +** "BusyHandler typedefs. +*/ +/************** Include btree.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/ +/************** Begin file btree.h *******************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 15 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite B-Tree file +** subsystem. See comments in the source code for a detailed description +** of what each interface routine does. +** +** @(#) $Id: btree.h,v 1.94 2007/12/07 18:55:28 drh Exp $ +*/ +#ifndef _BTREE_H_ +#define _BTREE_H_ + +/* TODO: This definition is just included so other modules compile. It +** needs to be revisited. +*/ +#define SQLITE_N_BTREE_META 10 + +/* +** If defined as non-zero, auto-vacuum is enabled by default. Otherwise +** it must be turned on for each database using "PRAGMA auto_vacuum = 1". +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM + #define SQLITE_DEFAULT_AUTOVACUUM 0 +#endif + +#define BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_NONE 0 /* Do not do auto-vacuum */ +#define BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_FULL 1 /* Do full auto-vacuum */ +#define BTREE_AUTOVACUUM_INCR 2 /* Incremental vacuum */ + +/* +** Forward declarations of structure +*/ +typedef struct Btree Btree; +typedef struct BtCursor BtCursor; +typedef struct BtShared BtShared; +typedef struct BtreeMutexArray BtreeMutexArray; + +/* +** This structure records all of the Btrees that need to hold +** a mutex before we enter sqlite3VdbeExec(). The Btrees are +** are placed in aBtree[] in order of aBtree[]->pBt. That way, +** we can always lock and unlock them all quickly. +*/ +struct BtreeMutexArray { + int nMutex; + Btree *aBtree[SQLITE_MAX_ATTACHED+1]; +}; + + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeOpen( + const char *zFilename, /* Name of database file to open */ + sqlite3 *db, /* Associated database connection */ + Btree **, /* Return open Btree* here */ + int flags, /* Flags */ + int vfsFlags /* Flags passed through to VFS open */ +); + +/* The flags parameter to sqlite3BtreeOpen can be the bitwise or of the +** following values. +** +** NOTE: These values must match the corresponding PAGER_ values in +** pager.h. +*/ +#define BTREE_OMIT_JOURNAL 1 /* Do not use journal. No argument */ +#define BTREE_NO_READLOCK 2 /* Omit readlocks on readonly files */ +#define BTREE_MEMORY 4 /* In-memory DB. No argument */ +#define BTREE_READONLY 8 /* Open the database in read-only mode */ +#define BTREE_READWRITE 16 /* Open for both reading and writing */ +#define BTREE_CREATE 32 /* Create the database if it does not exist */ + +/* Additional values for the 4th argument of sqlite3BtreeOpen that +** are not associated with PAGER_ values. +*/ +#define BTREE_PRIVATE 64 /* Never share with other connections */ + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeClose(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetCacheSize(Btree*,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetSafetyLevel(Btree*,int,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSyncDisabled(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetPageSize(Btree*,int,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetPageSize(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeMaxPageCount(Btree*,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetReserve(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSetAutoVacuum(Btree *, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetAutoVacuum(Btree *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeBeginTrans(Btree*,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseOne(Btree*, const char *zMaster); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommitPhaseTwo(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommit(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeRollback(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeBeginStmt(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCommitStmt(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeRollbackStmt(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCreateTable(Btree*, int*, int flags); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsInTrans(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsInStmt(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIsInReadTrans(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3BtreeSchema(Btree *, int, void(*)(void *)); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeSchemaLocked(Btree *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeLockTable(Btree *, int, u8); + +SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3BtreeGetFilename(Btree *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3BtreeGetDirname(Btree *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3BtreeGetJournalname(Btree *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCopyFile(Btree *, Btree *); + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeIncrVacuum(Btree *); + +/* The flags parameter to sqlite3BtreeCreateTable can be the bitwise OR +** of the following flags: +*/ +#define BTREE_INTKEY 1 /* Table has only 64-bit signed integer keys */ +#define BTREE_ZERODATA 2 /* Table has keys only - no data */ +#define BTREE_LEAFDATA 4 /* Data stored in leaves only. Implies INTKEY */ + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeDropTable(Btree*, int, int*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeClearTable(Btree*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeGetMeta(Btree*, int idx, u32 *pValue); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeUpdateMeta(Btree*, int idx, u32 value); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeTripAllCursors(Btree*, int); + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursor( + Btree*, /* BTree containing table to open */ + int iTable, /* Index of root page */ + int wrFlag, /* 1 for writing. 0 for read-only */ + int(*)(void*,int,const void*,int,const void*), /* Key comparison function */ + void*, /* First argument to compare function */ + BtCursor **ppCursor /* Returned cursor */ +); + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCloseCursor(BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeMoveto(BtCursor*,const void *pKey,i64 nKey,int bias,int *pRes); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeDelete(BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeInsert(BtCursor*, const void *pKey, i64 nKey, + const void *pData, int nData, + int nZero, int bias); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeFirst(BtCursor*, int *pRes); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeLast(BtCursor*, int *pRes); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeNext(BtCursor*, int *pRes); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeEof(BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeFlags(BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePrevious(BtCursor*, int *pRes); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeKeySize(BtCursor*, i64 *pSize); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeKey(BtCursor*, u32 offset, u32 amt, void*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3 *sqlite3BtreeCursorDb(const BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const void *sqlite3BtreeKeyFetch(BtCursor*, int *pAmt); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const void *sqlite3BtreeDataFetch(BtCursor*, int *pAmt); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeDataSize(BtCursor*, u32 *pSize); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeData(BtCursor*, u32 offset, u32 amt, void*); + +SQLITE_PRIVATE char *sqlite3BtreeIntegrityCheck(Btree*, int *aRoot, int nRoot, int, int*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE struct Pager *sqlite3BtreePager(Btree*); + +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePutData(BtCursor*, u32 offset, u32 amt, void*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCacheOverflow(BtCursor *); + +#ifdef SQLITE_TEST +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeCursorInfo(BtCursor*, int*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeCursorList(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreePageDump(Btree*, int, int recursive); +#endif + +/* +** If we are not using shared cache, then there is no need to +** use mutexes to access the BtShared structures. So make the +** Enter and Leave procedures no-ops. +*/ +#if !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_SHARED_CACHE) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeEnter(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeLeave(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(Btree*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeEnterCursor(BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeLeaveCursor(BtCursor*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeEnterAll(sqlite3*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeLeaveAll(sqlite3*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3BtreeHoldsAllMutexes(sqlite3*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeMutexArrayEnter(BtreeMutexArray*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeMutexArrayLeave(BtreeMutexArray*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3BtreeMutexArrayInsert(BtreeMutexArray*, Btree*); +#else +# define sqlite3BtreeEnter(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeLeave(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeHoldsMutex(X) 1 +# define sqlite3BtreeEnterCursor(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeLeaveCursor(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeEnterAll(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeLeaveAll(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeHoldsAllMutexes(X) 1 +# define sqlite3BtreeMutexArrayEnter(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeMutexArrayLeave(X) +# define sqlite3BtreeMutexArrayInsert(X,Y) +#endif + + +#endif /* _BTREE_H_ */ + +/************** End of btree.h ***********************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Include vdbe.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Begin file vdbe.h ********************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 15 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** Header file for the Virtual DataBase Engine (VDBE) +** +** This header defines the interface to the virtual database engine +** or VDBE. The VDBE implements an abstract machine that runs a +** simple program to access and modify the underlying database. +** +** $Id: vdbe.h,v 1.115 2007/11/14 06:48:48 danielk1977 Exp $ +*/ +#ifndef _SQLITE_VDBE_H_ +#define _SQLITE_VDBE_H_ + +/* +** A single VDBE is an opaque structure named "Vdbe". Only routines +** in the source file sqliteVdbe.c are allowed to see the insides +** of this structure. +*/ +typedef struct Vdbe Vdbe; + +/* +** A single instruction of the virtual machine has an opcode +** and as many as three operands. The instruction is recorded +** as an instance of the following structure: +*/ +struct VdbeOp { + u8 opcode; /* What operation to perform */ + int p1; /* First operand */ + int p2; /* Second parameter (often the jump destination) */ + char *p3; /* Third parameter */ + int p3type; /* One of the P3_xxx constants defined below */ +#ifdef VDBE_PROFILE + int cnt; /* Number of times this instruction was executed */ + long long cycles; /* Total time spend executing this instruction */ +#endif +}; +typedef struct VdbeOp VdbeOp; + +/* +** A smaller version of VdbeOp used for the VdbeAddOpList() function because +** it takes up less space. +*/ +struct VdbeOpList { + u8 opcode; /* What operation to perform */ + signed char p1; /* First operand */ + short int p2; /* Second parameter (often the jump destination) */ + char *p3; /* Third parameter */ +}; +typedef struct VdbeOpList VdbeOpList; + +/* +** Allowed values of VdbeOp.p3type +*/ +#define P3_NOTUSED 0 /* The P3 parameter is not used */ +#define P3_DYNAMIC (-1) /* Pointer to a string obtained from sqliteMalloc() */ +#define P3_STATIC (-2) /* Pointer to a static string */ +#define P3_COLLSEQ (-4) /* P3 is a pointer to a CollSeq structure */ +#define P3_FUNCDEF (-5) /* P3 is a pointer to a FuncDef structure */ +#define P3_KEYINFO (-6) /* P3 is a pointer to a KeyInfo structure */ +#define P3_VDBEFUNC (-7) /* P3 is a pointer to a VdbeFunc structure */ +#define P3_MEM (-8) /* P3 is a pointer to a Mem* structure */ +#define P3_TRANSIENT (-9) /* P3 is a pointer to a transient string */ +#define P3_VTAB (-10) /* P3 is a pointer to an sqlite3_vtab structure */ +#define P3_MPRINTF (-11) /* P3 is a string obtained from sqlite3_mprintf() */ +#define P3_REAL (-12) /* P3 is a 64-bit floating point value */ +#define P3_INT64 (-13) /* P3 is a 64-bit signed integer */ + +/* When adding a P3 argument using P3_KEYINFO, a copy of the KeyInfo structure +** is made. That copy is freed when the Vdbe is finalized. But if the +** argument is P3_KEYINFO_HANDOFF, the passed in pointer is used. It still +** gets freed when the Vdbe is finalized so it still should be obtained +** from a single sqliteMalloc(). But no copy is made and the calling +** function should *not* try to free the KeyInfo. +*/ +#define P3_KEYINFO_HANDOFF (-9) + +/* +** The Vdbe.aColName array contains 5n Mem structures, where n is the +** number of columns of data returned by the statement. +*/ +#define COLNAME_NAME 0 +#define COLNAME_DECLTYPE 1 +#define COLNAME_DATABASE 2 +#define COLNAME_TABLE 3 +#define COLNAME_COLUMN 4 +#define COLNAME_N 5 /* Number of COLNAME_xxx symbols */ + +/* +** The following macro converts a relative address in the p2 field +** of a VdbeOp structure into a negative number so that +** sqlite3VdbeAddOpList() knows that the address is relative. Calling +** the macro again restores the address. +*/ +#define ADDR(X) (-1-(X)) + +/* +** The makefile scans the vdbe.c source file and creates the "opcodes.h" +** header file that defines a number for each opcode used by the VDBE. +*/ +/************** Include opcodes.h in the middle of vdbe.h ********************/ +/************** Begin file opcodes.h *****************************************/ +/* Automatically generated. Do not edit */ +/* See the mkopcodeh.awk script for details */ +#define OP_MemLoad 1 +#define OP_VNext 2 +#define OP_HexBlob 126 /* same as TK_BLOB */ +#define OP_Column 3 +#define OP_SetCookie 4 +#define OP_IfMemPos 5 +#define OP_Real 125 /* same as TK_FLOAT */ +#define OP_Sequence 6 +#define OP_MoveGt 7 +#define OP_Ge 72 /* same as TK_GE */ +#define OP_RowKey 8 +#define OP_Eq 68 /* same as TK_EQ */ +#define OP_OpenWrite 9 +#define OP_NotNull 66 /* same as TK_NOTNULL */ +#define OP_If 10 +#define OP_ToInt 141 /* same as TK_TO_INT */ +#define OP_String8 88 /* same as TK_STRING */ +#define OP_Pop 11 +#define OP_VRowid 12 +#define OP_CollSeq 13 +#define OP_OpenRead 14 +#define OP_Expire 15 +#define OP_AutoCommit 17 +#define OP_Gt 69 /* same as TK_GT */ +#define OP_IntegrityCk 18 +#define OP_Sort 19 +#define OP_Function 20 +#define OP_And 61 /* same as TK_AND */ +#define OP_Subtract 79 /* same as TK_MINUS */ +#define OP_Noop 21 +#define OP_Return 22 +#define OP_Remainder 82 /* same as TK_REM */ +#define OP_NewRowid 23 +#define OP_Multiply 80 /* same as TK_STAR */ +#define OP_IfMemNeg 24 +#define OP_Variable 25 +#define OP_String 26 +#define OP_RealAffinity 27 +#define OP_VRename 28 +#define OP_ParseSchema 29 +#define OP_VOpen 30 +#define OP_Close 31 +#define OP_CreateIndex 32 +#define OP_IsUnique 33 +#define OP_NotFound 34 +#define OP_Int64 35 +#define OP_MustBeInt 36 +#define OP_Halt 37 +#define OP_Rowid 38 +#define OP_IdxLT 39 +#define OP_AddImm 40 +#define OP_Statement 41 +#define OP_RowData 42 +#define OP_MemMax 43 +#define OP_Push 44 +#define OP_Or 60 /* same as TK_OR */ +#define OP_NotExists 45 +#define OP_MemIncr 46 +#define OP_Gosub 47 +#define OP_Divide 81 /* same as TK_SLASH */ +#define OP_Integer 48 +#define OP_ToNumeric 140 /* same as TK_TO_NUMERIC*/ +#define OP_MemInt 49 +#define OP_Prev 50 +#define OP_Concat 83 /* same as TK_CONCAT */ +#define OP_BitAnd 74 /* same as TK_BITAND */ +#define OP_VColumn 51 +#define OP_CreateTable 52 +#define OP_Last 53 +#define OP_IsNull 65 /* same as TK_ISNULL */ +#define OP_IncrVacuum 54 +#define OP_IdxRowid 55 +#define OP_MakeIdxRec 56 +#define OP_ShiftRight 77 /* same as TK_RSHIFT */ +#define OP_ResetCount 57 +#define OP_FifoWrite 58 +#define OP_Callback 59 +#define OP_ContextPush 62 +#define OP_DropTrigger 63 +#define OP_DropIndex 64 +#define OP_IdxGE 73 +#define OP_IdxDelete 84 +#define OP_Vacuum 86 +#define OP_MoveLe 89 +#define OP_IfNot 90 +#define OP_DropTable 91 +#define OP_MakeRecord 92 +#define OP_ToBlob 139 /* same as TK_TO_BLOB */ +#define OP_Delete 93 +#define OP_StackDepth 94 +#define OP_AggFinal 95 +#define OP_ShiftLeft 76 /* same as TK_LSHIFT */ +#define OP_Dup 96 +#define OP_Goto 97 +#define OP_TableLock 98 +#define OP_FifoRead 99 +#define OP_Clear 100 +#define OP_IdxGT 101 +#define OP_MoveLt 102 +#define OP_Le 70 /* same as TK_LE */ +#define OP_VerifyCookie 103 +#define OP_AggStep 104 +#define OP_Pull 105 +#define OP_ToText 138 /* same as TK_TO_TEXT */ +#define OP_Not 16 /* same as TK_NOT */ +#define OP_ToReal 142 /* same as TK_TO_REAL */ +#define OP_SetNumColumns 106 +#define OP_AbsValue 107 +#define OP_Transaction 108 +#define OP_VFilter 109 +#define OP_Negative 85 /* same as TK_UMINUS */ +#define OP_Ne 67 /* same as TK_NE */ +#define OP_VDestroy 110 +#define OP_ContextPop 111 +#define OP_BitOr 75 /* same as TK_BITOR */ +#define OP_Next 112 +#define OP_IdxInsert 113 +#define OP_Distinct 114 +#define OP_Lt 71 /* same as TK_LT */ +#define OP_Insert 115 +#define OP_Destroy 116 +#define OP_ReadCookie 117 +#define OP_ForceInt 118 +#define OP_LoadAnalysis 119 +#define OP_Explain 120 +#define OP_IfMemZero 121 +#define OP_OpenPseudo 122 +#define OP_OpenEphemeral 123 +#define OP_Null 124 +#define OP_Blob 127 +#define OP_Add 78 /* same as TK_PLUS */ +#define OP_MemStore 128 +#define OP_Rewind 129 +#define OP_MoveGe 130 +#define OP_VBegin 131 +#define OP_VUpdate 132 +#define OP_BitNot 87 /* same as TK_BITNOT */ +#define OP_VCreate 133 +#define OP_MemMove 134 +#define OP_MemNull 135 +#define OP_Found 136 +#define OP_NullRow 137 + +/* Opcodes that are guaranteed to never push a value onto the stack +** contain a 1 their corresponding position of the following mask +** set. See the opcodeNoPush() function in vdbeaux.c */ +#define NOPUSH_MASK_0 0xeeb4 +#define NOPUSH_MASK_1 0xf96b +#define NOPUSH_MASK_2 0xfbb6 +#define NOPUSH_MASK_3 0xfe64 +#define NOPUSH_MASK_4 0xffff +#define NOPUSH_MASK_5 0xeef7 +#define NOPUSH_MASK_6 0xf7f6 +#define NOPUSH_MASK_7 0x0ecf +#define NOPUSH_MASK_8 0x7f3f +#define NOPUSH_MASK_9 0x0000 + +/************** End of opcodes.h *********************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in vdbe.h ***********************/ + +/* +** Prototypes for the VDBE interface. See comments on the implementation +** for a description of what each of these routines does. +*/ +SQLITE_PRIVATE Vdbe *sqlite3VdbeCreate(sqlite3*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOp(Vdbe*,int,int,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeOp3(Vdbe*,int,int,int,const char *zP3,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeAddOpList(Vdbe*, int nOp, VdbeOpList const *aOp); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP1(Vdbe*, int addr, int P1); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP2(Vdbe*, int addr, int P2); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeJumpHere(Vdbe*, int addr); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeToNoop(Vdbe*, int addr, int N); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeChangeP3(Vdbe*, int addr, const char *zP1, int N); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeUsesBtree(Vdbe*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE VdbeOp *sqlite3VdbeGetOp(Vdbe*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeMakeLabel(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeDelete(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeMakeReady(Vdbe*,int,int,int,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeFinalize(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeResolveLabel(Vdbe*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeCurrentAddr(Vdbe*); +#ifdef SQLITE_DEBUG +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeTrace(Vdbe*,FILE*); +#endif +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeResetStepResult(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeReset(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetNumCols(Vdbe*,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3VdbeSetColName(Vdbe*, int, int, const char *, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeCountChanges(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3 *sqlite3VdbeDb(Vdbe*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSetSql(Vdbe*, const char *z, int n); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeSwap(Vdbe*,Vdbe*); + +#ifndef NDEBUG +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3VdbeComment(Vdbe*, const char*, ...); +# define VdbeComment(X) sqlite3VdbeComment X +#else +# define VdbeComment(X) +#endif + +#endif + +/************** End of vdbe.h ************************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Include pager.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/ +/************** Begin file pager.h *******************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 15 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** This header file defines the interface that the sqlite page cache +** subsystem. The page cache subsystem reads and writes a file a page +** at a time and provides a journal for rollback. +** +** @(#) $Id: pager.h,v 1.68 2007/11/28 16:19:56 drh Exp $ +*/ + +#ifndef _PAGER_H_ +#define _PAGER_H_ + +/* +** The type used to represent a page number. The first page in a file +** is called page 1. 0 is used to represent "not a page". +*/ +typedef unsigned int Pgno; + +/* +** Each open file is managed by a separate instance of the "Pager" structure. +*/ +typedef struct Pager Pager; + +/* +** Handle type for pages. +*/ +typedef struct PgHdr DbPage; + +/* +** Allowed values for the flags parameter to sqlite3PagerOpen(). +** +** NOTE: This values must match the corresponding BTREE_ values in btree.h. +*/ +#define PAGER_OMIT_JOURNAL 0x0001 /* Do not use a rollback journal */ +#define PAGER_NO_READLOCK 0x0002 /* Omit readlocks on readonly files */ + +/* +** Valid values for the second argument to sqlite3PagerLockingMode(). +*/ +#define PAGER_LOCKINGMODE_QUERY -1 +#define PAGER_LOCKINGMODE_NORMAL 0 +#define PAGER_LOCKINGMODE_EXCLUSIVE 1 + +/* +** See source code comments for a detailed description of the following +** routines: +*/ +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerOpen(sqlite3_vfs *, Pager **ppPager, const char*, int,int,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetBusyhandler(Pager*, BusyHandler *pBusyHandler); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetDestructor(Pager*, void(*)(DbPage*,int)); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetReiniter(Pager*, void(*)(DbPage*,int)); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerSetPagesize(Pager*, u16*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerMaxPageCount(Pager*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerReadFileheader(Pager*, int, unsigned char*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetCachesize(Pager*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerClose(Pager *pPager); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerAcquire(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, DbPage **ppPage, int clrFlag); +#define sqlite3PagerGet(A,B,C) sqlite3PagerAcquire(A,B,C,0) +SQLITE_PRIVATE DbPage *sqlite3PagerLookup(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerRef(DbPage*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerUnref(DbPage*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerWrite(DbPage*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerOverwrite(Pager *pPager, Pgno pgno, void*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerPagecount(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerTruncate(Pager*,Pgno); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerBegin(DbPage*, int exFlag); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseOne(Pager*,const char *zMaster, Pgno); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerCommitPhaseTwo(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerRollback(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerIsreadonly(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerStmtBegin(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerStmtCommit(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerStmtRollback(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerDontRollback(DbPage*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerDontWrite(DbPage*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerRefcount(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetSafetyLevel(Pager*,int,int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3PagerFilename(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const sqlite3_vfs *sqlite3PagerVfs(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_file *sqlite3PagerFile(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3PagerDirname(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE const char *sqlite3PagerJournalname(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerNosync(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerMovepage(Pager*,DbPage*,Pgno); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerGetData(DbPage *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerGetExtra(DbPage *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerLockingMode(Pager *, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3PagerTempSpace(Pager*); + +#if defined(SQLITE_ENABLE_MEMORY_MANAGEMENT) && !defined(SQLITE_OMIT_DISKIO) +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerReleaseMemory(int); +#endif + +#ifdef SQLITE_HAS_CODEC +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerSetCodec(Pager*,void*(*)(void*,void*,Pgno,int),void*); +#endif + +#if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(SQLITE_TEST) +SQLITE_PRIVATE Pgno sqlite3PagerPagenumber(DbPage*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3PagerIswriteable(DbPage*); +#endif + +#ifdef SQLITE_TEST +SQLITE_PRIVATE int *sqlite3PagerStats(Pager*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3PagerRefdump(Pager*); + int pager3_refinfo_enable; +#endif + +#ifdef SQLITE_TEST +void disable_simulated_io_errors(void); +void enable_simulated_io_errors(void); +#else +# define disable_simulated_io_errors() +# define enable_simulated_io_errors() +#endif + +#endif /* _PAGER_H_ */ + +/************** End of pager.h ***********************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ + + +/* +** Name of the master database table. The master database table +** is a special table that holds the names and attributes of all +** user tables and indices. +*/ +#define MASTER_NAME "sqlite_master" +#define TEMP_MASTER_NAME "sqlite_temp_master" + +/* +** The root-page of the master database table. +*/ +#define MASTER_ROOT 1 + +/* +** The name of the schema table. +*/ +#define SCHEMA_TABLE(x) ((!OMIT_TEMPDB)&&(x==1)?TEMP_MASTER_NAME:MASTER_NAME) + +/* +** A convenience macro that returns the number of elements in +** an array. +*/ +#define ArraySize(X) (sizeof(X)/sizeof(X[0])) + +/* +** Forward references to structures +*/ +typedef struct AggInfo AggInfo; +typedef struct AuthContext AuthContext; +typedef struct CollSeq CollSeq; +typedef struct Column Column; +typedef struct Db Db; +typedef struct Schema Schema; +typedef struct Expr Expr; +typedef struct ExprList ExprList; +typedef struct FKey FKey; +typedef struct FuncDef FuncDef; +typedef struct IdList IdList; +typedef struct Index Index; +typedef struct KeyClass KeyClass; +typedef struct KeyInfo KeyInfo; +typedef struct Module Module; +typedef struct NameContext NameContext; +typedef struct Parse Parse; +typedef struct Select Select; +typedef struct SrcList SrcList; +typedef struct StrAccum StrAccum; +typedef struct Table Table; +typedef struct TableLock TableLock; +typedef struct Token Token; +typedef struct TriggerStack TriggerStack; +typedef struct TriggerStep TriggerStep; +typedef struct Trigger Trigger; +typedef struct WhereInfo WhereInfo; +typedef struct WhereLevel WhereLevel; + +/************** Include os.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h ********************/ +/************** Begin file os.h **********************************************/ +/* +** 2001 September 16 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +****************************************************************************** +** +** This header file (together with is companion C source-code file +** "os.c") attempt to abstract the underlying operating system so that +** the SQLite library will work on both POSIX and windows systems. +** +** This header file is #include-ed by sqliteInt.h and thus ends up +** being included by every source file. +*/ +#ifndef _SQLITE_OS_H_ +#define _SQLITE_OS_H_ + +/* +** Figure out if we are dealing with Unix, Windows, or some other +** operating system. After the following block of preprocess macros, +** all of OS_UNIX, OS_WIN, OS_OS2, and OS_OTHER will defined to either +** 1 or 0. One of the four will be 1. The other three will be 0. +*/ +#if defined(OS_OTHER) +# if OS_OTHER==1 +# undef OS_UNIX +# define OS_UNIX 0 +# undef OS_WIN +# define OS_WIN 0 +# undef OS_OS2 +# define OS_OS2 0 +# else +# undef OS_OTHER +# endif +#endif +#if !defined(OS_UNIX) && !defined(OS_OTHER) +# define OS_OTHER 0 +# ifndef OS_WIN +# if defined(_WIN32) || defined(WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__) || defined(__MINGW32__) || defined(__BORLANDC__) +# define OS_WIN 1 +# define OS_UNIX 0 +# define OS_OS2 0 +# elif defined(__EMX__) || defined(_OS2) || defined(OS2) || defined(_OS2_) || defined(__OS2__) +# define OS_WIN 0 +# define OS_UNIX 0 +# define OS_OS2 1 +# else +# define OS_WIN 0 +# define OS_UNIX 1 +# define OS_OS2 0 +# endif +# else +# define OS_UNIX 0 +# define OS_OS2 0 +# endif +#else +# ifndef OS_WIN +# define OS_WIN 0 +# endif +#endif + + + +/* +** Define the maximum size of a temporary filename +*/ +#if OS_WIN +# include +# define SQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE (MAX_PATH+50) +#elif OS_OS2 +# if (__GNUC__ > 3 || __GNUC__ == 3 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 3) && defined(OS2_HIGH_MEMORY) +# include /* has to be included before os2.h for linking to work */ +# endif +# define INCL_DOSDATETIME +# define INCL_DOSFILEMGR +# define INCL_DOSERRORS +# define INCL_DOSMISC +# define INCL_DOSPROCESS +# define INCL_DOSMODULEMGR +# define INCL_DOSSEMAPHORES +# include +# define SQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE (CCHMAXPATHCOMP) +#else +# define SQLITE_TEMPNAME_SIZE 200 +#endif + +/* If the SET_FULLSYNC macro is not defined above, then make it +** a no-op +*/ +#ifndef SET_FULLSYNC +# define SET_FULLSYNC(x,y) +#endif + +/* +** The default size of a disk sector +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE +# define SQLITE_DEFAULT_SECTOR_SIZE 512 +#endif + +/* +** Temporary files are named starting with this prefix followed by 16 random +** alphanumeric characters, and no file extension. They are stored in the +** OS's standard temporary file directory, and are deleted prior to exit. +** If sqlite is being embedded in another program, you may wish to change the +** prefix to reflect your program's name, so that if your program exits +** prematurely, old temporary files can be easily identified. This can be done +** using -DSQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX=myprefix_ on the compiler command line. +** +** 2006-10-31: The default prefix used to be "sqlite_". But then +** Mcafee started using SQLite in their anti-virus product and it +** started putting files with the "sqlite" name in the c:/temp folder. +** This annoyed many windows users. Those users would then do a +** Google search for "sqlite", find the telephone numbers of the +** developers and call to wake them up at night and complain. +** For this reason, the default name prefix is changed to be "sqlite" +** spelled backwards. So the temp files are still identified, but +** anybody smart enough to figure out the code is also likely smart +** enough to know that calling the developer will not help get rid +** of the file. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX +# define SQLITE_TEMP_FILE_PREFIX "etilqs_" +#endif + +/* +** The following values may be passed as the second argument to +** sqlite3OsLock(). The various locks exhibit the following semantics: +** +** SHARED: Any number of processes may hold a SHARED lock simultaneously. +** RESERVED: A single process may hold a RESERVED lock on a file at +** any time. Other processes may hold and obtain new SHARED locks. +** PENDING: A single process may hold a PENDING lock on a file at +** any one time. Existing SHARED locks may persist, but no new +** SHARED locks may be obtained by other processes. +** EXCLUSIVE: An EXCLUSIVE lock precludes all other locks. +** +** PENDING_LOCK may not be passed directly to sqlite3OsLock(). Instead, a +** process that requests an EXCLUSIVE lock may actually obtain a PENDING +** lock. This can be upgraded to an EXCLUSIVE lock by a subsequent call to +** sqlite3OsLock(). +*/ +#define NO_LOCK 0 +#define SHARED_LOCK 1 +#define RESERVED_LOCK 2 +#define PENDING_LOCK 3 +#define EXCLUSIVE_LOCK 4 + +/* +** File Locking Notes: (Mostly about windows but also some info for Unix) +** +** We cannot use LockFileEx() or UnlockFileEx() on Win95/98/ME because +** those functions are not available. So we use only LockFile() and +** UnlockFile(). +** +** LockFile() prevents not just writing but also reading by other processes. +** A SHARED_LOCK is obtained by locking a single randomly-chosen +** byte out of a specific range of bytes. The lock byte is obtained at +** random so two separate readers can probably access the file at the +** same time, unless they are unlucky and choose the same lock byte. +** An EXCLUSIVE_LOCK is obtained by locking all bytes in the range. +** There can only be one writer. A RESERVED_LOCK is obtained by locking +** a single byte of the file that is designated as the reserved lock byte. +** A PENDING_LOCK is obtained by locking a designated byte different from +** the RESERVED_LOCK byte. +** +** On WinNT/2K/XP systems, LockFileEx() and UnlockFileEx() are available, +** which means we can use reader/writer locks. When reader/writer locks +** are used, the lock is placed on the same range of bytes that is used +** for probabilistic locking in Win95/98/ME. Hence, the locking scheme +** will support two or more Win95 readers or two or more WinNT readers. +** But a single Win95 reader will lock out all WinNT readers and a single +** WinNT reader will lock out all other Win95 readers. +** +** The following #defines specify the range of bytes used for locking. +** SHARED_SIZE is the number of bytes available in the pool from which +** a random byte is selected for a shared lock. The pool of bytes for +** shared locks begins at SHARED_FIRST. +** +** These #defines are available in sqlite_aux.h so that adaptors for +** connecting SQLite to other operating systems can use the same byte +** ranges for locking. In particular, the same locking strategy and +** byte ranges are used for Unix. This leaves open the possiblity of having +** clients on win95, winNT, and unix all talking to the same shared file +** and all locking correctly. To do so would require that samba (or whatever +** tool is being used for file sharing) implements locks correctly between +** windows and unix. I'm guessing that isn't likely to happen, but by +** using the same locking range we are at least open to the possibility. +** +** Locking in windows is manditory. For this reason, we cannot store +** actual data in the bytes used for locking. The pager never allocates +** the pages involved in locking therefore. SHARED_SIZE is selected so +** that all locks will fit on a single page even at the minimum page size. +** PENDING_BYTE defines the beginning of the locks. By default PENDING_BYTE +** is set high so that we don't have to allocate an unused page except +** for very large databases. But one should test the page skipping logic +** by setting PENDING_BYTE low and running the entire regression suite. +** +** Changing the value of PENDING_BYTE results in a subtly incompatible +** file format. Depending on how it is changed, you might not notice +** the incompatibility right away, even running a full regression test. +** The default location of PENDING_BYTE is the first byte past the +** 1GB boundary. +** +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_TEST +#define PENDING_BYTE 0x40000000 /* First byte past the 1GB boundary */ +#else +SQLITE_API extern unsigned int sqlite3_pending_byte; +#define PENDING_BYTE sqlite3_pending_byte +#endif + +#define RESERVED_BYTE (PENDING_BYTE+1) +#define SHARED_FIRST (PENDING_BYTE+2) +#define SHARED_SIZE 510 + +/* +** Functions for accessing sqlite3_file methods +*/ +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsClose(sqlite3_file*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsRead(sqlite3_file*, void*, int amt, i64 offset); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsWrite(sqlite3_file*, const void*, int amt, i64 offset); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsTruncate(sqlite3_file*, i64 size); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSync(sqlite3_file*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFileSize(sqlite3_file*, i64 *pSize); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsLock(sqlite3_file*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsUnlock(sqlite3_file*, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCheckReservedLock(sqlite3_file *id); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFileControl(sqlite3_file*,int,void*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSectorSize(sqlite3_file *id); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsDeviceCharacteristics(sqlite3_file *id); + +/* +** Functions for accessing sqlite3_vfs methods +*/ +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsOpen(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, sqlite3_file*, int, int *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsDelete(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsAccess(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsGetTempname(sqlite3_vfs *, int, char *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsFullPathname(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, int, char *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3OsDlOpen(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsDlError(sqlite3_vfs *, int, char *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void *sqlite3OsDlSym(sqlite3_vfs *, void *, const char *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE void sqlite3OsDlClose(sqlite3_vfs *, void *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsRandomness(sqlite3_vfs *, int, char *); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsSleep(sqlite3_vfs *, int); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCurrentTime(sqlite3_vfs *, double*); + +/* +** Convenience functions for opening and closing files using +** sqlite3_malloc() to obtain space for the file-handle structure. +*/ +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsOpenMalloc(sqlite3_vfs *, const char *, sqlite3_file **, int,int*); +SQLITE_PRIVATE int sqlite3OsCloseFree(sqlite3_file *); + +/* +** Each OS-specific backend defines an instance of the following +** structure for returning a pointer to its sqlite3_vfs. If OS_OTHER +** is defined (meaning that the application-defined OS interface layer +** is used) then there is no default VFS. The application must +** register one or more VFS structures using sqlite3_vfs_register() +** before attempting to use SQLite. +*/ +#if OS_UNIX || OS_WIN || OS_OS2 +SQLITE_PRIVATE sqlite3_vfs *sqlite3OsDefaultVfs(void); +#else +# define sqlite3OsDefaultVfs(X) 0 +#endif + +#endif /* _SQLITE_OS_H_ */ + +/************** End of os.h **************************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ +/************** Include mutex.h in the middle of sqliteInt.h *****************/ +/************** Begin file mutex.h *******************************************/ +/* +** 2007 August 28 +** +** The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of +** a legal notice, here is a blessing: +** +** May you do good and not evil. +** May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. +** May you share freely, never taking more than you give. +** +************************************************************************* +** +** This file contains the common header for all mutex implementations. +** The sqliteInt.h header #includes this file so that it is available +** to all source files. We break it out in an effort to keep the code +** better organized. +** +** NOTE: source files should *not* #include this header file directly. +** Source files should #include the sqliteInt.h file and let that file +** include this one indirectly. +** +** $Id: mutex.h,v 1.2 2007/08/30 14:10:30 drh Exp $ +*/ + + +#ifdef SQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF +/* +** If SQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF is defined, then this whole module is +** omitted and equivalent functionality must be provided by the +** application that links against the SQLite library. +*/ +#else +/* +** Figure out what version of the code to use. The choices are +** +** SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP For single-threaded applications that +** do not desire error checking. +** +** SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP_DEBUG For single-threaded applications with +** error checking to help verify that mutexes +** are being used correctly even though they +** are not needed. Used when SQLITE_DEBUG is +** defined on single-threaded builds. +** +** SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS For multi-threaded applications on Unix. +** +** SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 For multi-threaded applications on Win32. +** +** SQLITE_MUTEX_OS2 For multi-threaded applications on OS/2. +*/ +#define SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP 1 /* The default */ +#if defined(SQLITE_DEBUG) && !SQLITE_THREADSAFE +# undef SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP +# define SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP_DEBUG +#endif +#if defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE && OS_UNIX +# undef SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP +# define SQLITE_MUTEX_PTHREADS +#endif +#if defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE && OS_WIN +# undef SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP +# define SQLITE_MUTEX_W32 +#endif +#if defined(SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP) && SQLITE_THREADSAFE && OS_OS2 +# undef SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP +# define SQLITE_MUTEX_OS2 +#endif + +#ifdef SQLITE_MUTEX_NOOP +/* +** If this is a no-op implementation, implement everything as macros. +*/ +#define sqlite3_mutex_alloc(X) ((sqlite3_mutex*)8) +#define sqlite3_mutex_free(X) +#define sqlite3_mutex_enter(X) +#define sqlite3_mutex_try(X) SQLITE_OK +#define sqlite3_mutex_leave(X) +#define sqlite3_mutex_held(X) 1 +#define sqlite3_mutex_notheld(X) 1 +#endif + +#endif /* SQLITE_MUTEX_APPDEF */ + +/************** End of mutex.h ***********************************************/ +/************** Continuing where we left off in sqliteInt.h ******************/ + +/* +** Each database file to be accessed by the system is an instance +** of the following structure. There are normally two of these structures +** in the sqlite.aDb[] array. aDb[0] is the main database file and +** aDb[1] is the database file used to hold temporary tables. Additional +** databases may be attached. +*/ +struct Db { + char *zName; /* Name of this database */ + Btree *pBt; /* The B*Tree structure for this database file */ + u8 inTrans; /* 0: not writable. 1: Transaction. 2: Checkpoint */ + u8 safety_level; /* How aggressive at synching data to disk */ + void *pAux; /* Auxiliary data. Usually NULL */ + void (*xFreeAux)(void*); /* Routine to free pAux */ + Schema *pSchema; /* Pointer to database schema (possibly shared) */ +}; + +/* +** An instance of the following structure stores a database schema. +** +** If there are no virtual tables configured in this schema, the +** Schema.db variable is set to NULL. After the first virtual table +** has been added, it is set to point to the database connection +** used to create the connection. Once a virtual table has been +** added to the Schema structure and the Schema.db variable populated, +** only that database connection may use the Schema to prepare +** statements. +*/ +struct Schema { + int schema_cookie; /* Database schema version number for this file */ + Hash tblHash; /* All tables indexed by name */ + Hash idxHash; /* All (named) indices indexed by name */ + Hash trigHash; /* All triggers indexed by name */ + Hash aFKey; /* Foreign keys indexed by to-table */ + Table *pSeqTab; /* The sqlite_sequence table used by AUTOINCREMENT */ + u8 file_format; /* Schema format version for this file */ + u8 enc; /* Text encoding used by this database */ + u16 flags; /* Flags associated with this schema */ + int cache_size; /* Number of pages to use in the cache */ +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE + sqlite3 *db; /* "Owner" connection. See comment above */ +#endif +}; + +/* +** These macros can be used to test, set, or clear bits in the +** Db.flags field. +*/ +#define DbHasProperty(D,I,P) (((D)->aDb[I].pSchema->flags&(P))==(P)) +#define DbHasAnyProperty(D,I,P) (((D)->aDb[I].pSchema->flags&(P))!=0) +#define DbSetProperty(D,I,P) (D)->aDb[I].pSchema->flags|=(P) +#define DbClearProperty(D,I,P) (D)->aDb[I].pSchema->flags&=~(P) + +/* +** Allowed values for the DB.flags field. +** +** The DB_SchemaLoaded flag is set after the database schema has been +** read into internal hash tables. +** +** DB_UnresetViews means that one or more views have column names that +** have been filled out. If the schema changes, these column names might +** changes and so the view will need to be reset. +*/ +#define DB_SchemaLoaded 0x0001 /* The schema has been loaded */ +#define DB_UnresetViews 0x0002 /* Some views have defined column names */ +#define DB_Empty 0x0004 /* The file is empty (length 0 bytes) */ + + +/* +** Each database is an instance of the following structure. +** +** The sqlite.lastRowid records the last insert rowid generated by an +** insert statement. Inserts on views do not affect its value. Each +** trigger has its own context, so that lastRowid can be updated inside +** triggers as usual. The previous value will be restored once the trigger +** exits. Upon entering a before or instead of trigger, lastRowid is no +** longer (since after version 2.8.12) reset to -1. +** +** The sqlite.nChange does not count changes within triggers and keeps no +** context. It is reset at start of sqlite3_exec. +** The sqlite.lsChange represents the number of changes made by the last +** insert, update, or delete statement. It remains constant throughout the +** length of a statement and is then updated by OP_SetCounts. It keeps a +** context stack just like lastRowid so that the count of changes +** within a trigger is not seen outside the trigger. Changes to views do not +** affect the value of lsChange. +** The sqlite.csChange keeps track of the number of current changes (since +** the last statement) and is used to update sqlite_lsChange. +** +** The member variables sqlite.errCode, sqlite.zErrMsg and sqlite.zErrMsg16 +** store the most recent error code and, if applicable, string. The +** internal function sqlite3Error() is used to set these variables +** consistently. +*/ +struct sqlite3 { + sqlite3_vfs *pVfs; /* OS Interface */ + int nDb; /* Number of backends currently in use */ + Db *aDb; /* All backends */ + int flags; /* Miscellanous flags. See below */ + int openFlags; /* Flags passed to sqlite3_vfs.xOpen() */ + int errCode; /* Most recent error code (SQLITE_*) */ + int errMask; /* & result codes with this before returning */ + u8 autoCommit; /* The auto-commit flag. */ + u8 temp_store; /* 1: file 2: memory 0: default */ + u8 mallocFailed; /* True if we have seen a malloc failure */ + char nextAutovac; /* Autovac setting after VACUUM if >=0 */ + int nTable; /* Number of tables in the database */ + CollSeq *pDfltColl; /* The default collating sequence (BINARY) */ + i64 lastRowid; /* ROWID of most recent insert (see above) */ + i64 priorNewRowid; /* Last randomly generated ROWID */ + int magic; /* Magic number for detect library misuse */ + int nChange; /* Value returned by sqlite3_changes() */ + int nTotalChange; /* Value returned by sqlite3_total_changes() */ + sqlite3_mutex *mutex; /* Connection mutex */ + struct sqlite3InitInfo { /* Information used during initialization */ + int iDb; /* When back is being initialized */ + int newTnum; /* Rootpage of table being initialized */ + u8 busy; /* TRUE if currently initializing */ + } init; + int nExtension; /* Number of loaded extensions */ + void **aExtension; /* Array of shared libraray handles */ + struct Vdbe *pVdbe; /* List of active virtual machines */ + int activeVdbeCnt; /* Number of vdbes currently executing */ + void (*xTrace)(void*,const char*); /* Trace function */ + void *pTraceArg; /* Argument to the trace function */ + void (*xProfile)(void*,const char*,u64); /* Profiling function */ + void *pProfileArg; /* Argument to profile function */ + void *pCommitArg; /* Argument to xCommitCallback() */ + int (*xCommitCallback)(void*); /* Invoked at every commit. */ + void *pRollbackArg; /* Argument to xRollbackCallback() */ + void (*xRollbackCallback)(void*); /* Invoked at every commit. */ + void *pUpdateArg; + void (*xUpdateCallback)(void*,int, const char*,const char*,sqlite_int64); + void(*xCollNeeded)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const char*); + void(*xCollNeeded16)(void*,sqlite3*,int eTextRep,const void*); + void *pCollNeededArg; + sqlite3_value *pErr; /* Most recent error message */ + char *zErrMsg; /* Most recent error message (UTF-8 encoded) */ + char *zErrMsg16; /* Most recent error message (UTF-16 encoded) */ + union { + int isInterrupted; /* True if sqlite3_interrupt has been called */ + double notUsed1; /* Spacer */ + } u1; +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_AUTHORIZATION + int (*xAuth)(void*,int,const char*,const char*,const char*,const char*); + /* Access authorization function */ + void *pAuthArg; /* 1st argument to the access auth function */ +#endif +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_PROGRESS_CALLBACK + int (*xProgress)(void *); /* The progress callback */ + void *pProgressArg; /* Argument to the progress callback */ + int nProgressOps; /* Number of opcodes for progress callback */ +#endif +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE + Hash aModule; /* populated by sqlite3_create_module() */ + Table *pVTab; /* vtab with active Connect/Create method */ + sqlite3_vtab **aVTrans; /* Virtual tables with open transactions */ + int nVTrans; /* Allocated size of aVTrans */ +#endif + Hash aFunc; /* All functions that can be in SQL exprs */ + Hash aCollSeq; /* All collating sequences */ + BusyHandler busyHandler; /* Busy callback */ + int busyTimeout; /* Busy handler timeout, in msec */ + Db aDbStatic[2]; /* Static space for the 2 default backends */ +#ifdef SQLITE_SSE + sqlite3_stmt *pFetch; /* Used by SSE to fetch stored statements */ +#endif + u8 dfltLockMode; /* Default locking-mode for attached dbs */ +}; + +/* +** A macro to discover the encoding of a database. +*/ +#define ENC(db) ((db)->aDb[0].pSchema->enc) + +/* +** Possible values for the sqlite.flags and or Db.flags fields. +** +** On sqlite.flags, the SQLITE_InTrans value means that we have +** executed a BEGIN. On Db.flags, SQLITE_InTrans means a statement +** transaction is active on that particular database file. +*/ +#define SQLITE_VdbeTrace 0x00000001 /* True to trace VDBE execution */ +#define SQLITE_InTrans 0x00000008 /* True if in a transaction */ +#define SQLITE_InternChanges 0x00000010 /* Uncommitted Hash table changes */ +#define SQLITE_FullColNames 0x00000020 /* Show full column names on SELECT */ +#define SQLITE_ShortColNames 0x00000040 /* Show short columns names */ +#define SQLITE_CountRows 0x00000080 /* Count rows changed by INSERT, */ + /* DELETE, or UPDATE and return */ + /* the count using a callback. */ +#define SQLITE_NullCallback 0x00000100 /* Invoke the callback once if the */ + /* result set is empty */ +#define SQLITE_SqlTrace 0x00000200 /* Debug print SQL as it executes */ +#define SQLITE_VdbeListing 0x00000400 /* Debug listings of VDBE programs */ +#define SQLITE_WriteSchema 0x00000800 /* OK to update SQLITE_MASTER */ +#define SQLITE_NoReadlock 0x00001000 /* Readlocks are omitted when + ** accessing read-only databases */ +#define SQLITE_IgnoreChecks 0x00002000 /* Do not enforce check constraints */ +#define SQLITE_ReadUncommitted 0x00004000 /* For shared-cache mode */ +#define SQLITE_LegacyFileFmt 0x00008000 /* Create new databases in format 1 */ +#define SQLITE_FullFSync 0x00010000 /* Use full fsync on the backend */ +#define SQLITE_LoadExtension 0x00020000 /* Enable load_extension */ + +#define SQLITE_RecoveryMode 0x00040000 /* Ignore schema errors */ +#define SQLITE_SharedCache 0x00080000 /* Cache sharing is enabled */ +#define SQLITE_Vtab 0x00100000 /* There exists a virtual table */ + +/* +** Possible values for the sqlite.magic field. +** The numbers are obtained at random and have no special meaning, other +** than being distinct from one another. +*/ +#define SQLITE_MAGIC_OPEN 0xa029a697 /* Database is open */ +#define SQLITE_MAGIC_CLOSED 0x9f3c2d33 /* Database is closed */ +#define SQLITE_MAGIC_BUSY 0xf03b7906 /* Database currently in use */ +#define SQLITE_MAGIC_ERROR 0xb5357930 /* An SQLITE_MISUSE error occurred */ + +/* +** Each SQL function is defined by an instance of the following +** structure. A pointer to this structure is stored in the sqlite.aFunc +** hash table. When multiple functions have the same name, the hash table +** points to a linked list of these structures. +*/ +struct FuncDef { + i16 nArg; /* Number of arguments. -1 means unlimited */ + u8 iPrefEnc; /* Preferred text encoding (SQLITE_UTF8, 16LE, 16BE) */ + u8 needCollSeq; /* True if sqlite3GetFuncCollSeq() might be called */ + u8 flags; /* Some combination of SQLITE_FUNC_* */ + void *pUserData; /* User data parameter */ + FuncDef *pNext; /* Next function with same name */ + void (*xFunc)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**); /* Regular function */ + void (*xStep)(sqlite3_context*,int,sqlite3_value**); /* Aggregate step */ + void (*xFinalize)(sqlite3_context*); /* Aggregate finializer */ + char zName[1]; /* SQL name of the function. MUST BE LAST */ +}; + +/* +** Each SQLite module (virtual table definition) is defined by an +** instance of the following structure, stored in the sqlite3.aModule +** hash table. +*/ +struct Module { + const sqlite3_module *pModule; /* Callback pointers */ + const char *zName; /* Name passed to create_module() */ + void *pAux; /* pAux passed to create_module() */ + void (*xDestroy)(void *); /* Module destructor function */ +}; + +/* +** Possible values for FuncDef.flags +*/ +#define SQLITE_FUNC_LIKE 0x01 /* Candidate for the LIKE optimization */ +#define SQLITE_FUNC_CASE 0x02 /* Case-sensitive LIKE-type function */ +#define SQLITE_FUNC_EPHEM 0x04 /* Ephermeral. Delete with VDBE */ + +/* +** information about each column of an SQL table is held in an instance +** of this structure. +*/ +struct Column { + char *zName; /* Name of this column */ + Expr *pDflt; /* Default value of this column */ + char *zType; /* Data type for this column */ + char *zColl; /* Collating sequence. If NULL, use the default */ + u8 notNull; /* True if there is a NOT NULL constraint */ + u8 isPrimKey; /* True if this column is part of the PRIMARY KEY */ + char affinity; /* One of the SQLITE_AFF_... values */ +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE + u8 isHidden; /* True if this column is 'hidden' */ +#endif +}; + +/* +** A "Collating Sequence" is defined by an instance of the following +** structure. Conceptually, a collating sequence consists of a name and +** a comparison routine that defines the order of that sequence. +** +** There may two seperate implementations of the collation function, one +** that processes text in UTF-8 encoding (CollSeq.xCmp) and another that +** processes text encoded in UTF-16 (CollSeq.xCmp16), using the machine +** native byte order. When a collation sequence is invoked, SQLite selects +** the version that will require the least expensive encoding +** translations, if any. +** +** The CollSeq.pUser member variable is an extra parameter that passed in +** as the first argument to the UTF-8 comparison function, xCmp. +** CollSeq.pUser16 is the equivalent for the UTF-16 comparison function, +** xCmp16. +** +** If both CollSeq.xCmp and CollSeq.xCmp16 are NULL, it means that the +** collating sequence is undefined. Indices built on an undefined +** collating sequence may not be read or written. +*/ +struct CollSeq { + char *zName; /* Name of the collating sequence, UTF-8 encoded */ + u8 enc; /* Text encoding handled by xCmp() */ + u8 type; /* One of the SQLITE_COLL_... values below */ + void *pUser; /* First argument to xCmp() */ + int (*xCmp)(void*,int, const void*, int, const void*); + void (*xDel)(void*); /* Destructor for pUser */ +}; + +/* +** Allowed values of CollSeq flags: +*/ +#define SQLITE_COLL_BINARY 1 /* The default memcmp() collating sequence */ +#define SQLITE_COLL_NOCASE 2 /* The built-in NOCASE collating sequence */ +#define SQLITE_COLL_REVERSE 3 /* The built-in REVERSE collating sequence */ +#define SQLITE_COLL_USER 0 /* Any other user-defined collating sequence */ + +/* +** A sort order can be either ASC or DESC. +*/ +#define SQLITE_SO_ASC 0 /* Sort in ascending order */ +#define SQLITE_SO_DESC 1 /* Sort in ascending order */ + +/* +** Column affinity types. +** +** These used to have mnemonic name like 'i' for SQLITE_AFF_INTEGER and +** 't' for SQLITE_AFF_TEXT. But we can save a little space and improve +** the speed a little by number the values consecutively. +** +** But rather than start with 0 or 1, we begin with 'a'. That way, +** when multiple affinity types are concatenated into a string and +** used as the P3 operand, they will be more readable. +** +** Note also that the numeric types are grouped together so that testing +** for a numeric type is a single comparison. +*/ +#define SQLITE_AFF_TEXT 'a' +#define SQLITE_AFF_NONE 'b' +#define SQLITE_AFF_NUMERIC 'c' +#define SQLITE_AFF_INTEGER 'd' +#define SQLITE_AFF_REAL 'e' + +#define sqlite3IsNumericAffinity(X) ((X)>=SQLITE_AFF_NUMERIC) + +/* +** Each SQL table is represented in memory by an instance of the +** following structure. +** +** Table.zName is the name of the table. The case of the original +** CREATE TABLE statement is stored, but case is not significant for +** comparisons. +** +** Table.nCol is the number of columns in this table. Table.aCol is a +** pointer to an array of Column structures, one for each column. +** +** If the table has an INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, then Table.iPKey is the index of +** the column that is that key. Otherwise Table.iPKey is negative. Note +** that the datatype of the PRIMARY KEY must be INTEGER for this field to +** be set. An INTEGER PRIMARY KEY is used as the rowid for each row of +** the table. If a table has no INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, then a random rowid +** is generated for each row of the table. Table.hasPrimKey is true if +** the table has any PRIMARY KEY, INTEGER or otherwise. +** +** Table.tnum is the page number for the root BTree page of the table in the +** database file. If Table.iDb is the index of the database table backend +** in sqlite.aDb[]. 0 is for the main database and 1 is for the file that +** holds temporary tables and indices. If Table.isEphem +** is true, then the table is stored in a file that is automatically deleted +** when the VDBE cursor to the table is closed. In this case Table.tnum +** refers VDBE cursor number that holds the table open, not to the root +** page number. Transient tables are used to hold the results of a +** sub-query that appears instead of a real table name in the FROM clause +** of a SELECT statement. +*/ +struct Table { + char *zName; /* Name of the table */ + int nCol; /* Number of columns in this table */ + Column *aCol; /* Information about each column */ + int iPKey; /* If not less then 0, use aCol[iPKey] as the primary key */ + Index *pIndex; /* List of SQL indexes on this table. */ + int tnum; /* Root BTree node for this table (see note above) */ + Select *pSelect; /* NULL for tables. Points to definition if a view. */ + int nRef; /* Number of pointers to this Table */ + Trigger *pTrigger; /* List of SQL triggers on this table */ + FKey *pFKey; /* Linked list of all foreign keys in this table */ + char *zColAff; /* String defining the affinity of each column */ +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_CHECK + Expr *pCheck; /* The AND of all CHECK constraints */ +#endif +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_ALTERTABLE + int addColOffset; /* Offset in CREATE TABLE statement to add a new column */ +#endif + u8 readOnly; /* True if this table should not be written by the user */ + u8 isEphem; /* True if created using OP_OpenEphermeral */ + u8 hasPrimKey; /* True if there exists a primary key */ + u8 keyConf; /* What to do in case of uniqueness conflict on iPKey */ + u8 autoInc; /* True if the integer primary key is autoincrement */ +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE + u8 isVirtual; /* True if this is a virtual table */ + u8 isCommit; /* True once the CREATE TABLE has been committed */ + Module *pMod; /* Pointer to the implementation of the module */ + sqlite3_vtab *pVtab; /* Pointer to the module instance */ + int nModuleArg; /* Number of arguments to the module */ + char **azModuleArg; /* Text of all module args. [0] is module name */ +#endif + Schema *pSchema; /* Schema that contains this table */ +}; + +/* +** Test to see whether or not a table is a virtual table. This is +** done as a macro so that it will be optimized out when virtual +** table support is omitted from the build. +*/ +#ifndef SQLITE_OMIT_VIRTUALTABLE +# define IsVirtual(X) ((X)->isVirtual) +# define IsHiddenColumn(X) ((X)->isHidden) +#else +# define IsVirtual(X) 0 +# define IsHiddenColumn(X) 0 +#endif + +/* +** Each foreign key constraint is an instance of the following structure. +** +** A foreign key is associated with two tables. The "from" table is +** the table that contains the REFERENCES clause that creates the foreign +** key. The "to" table is the table that is named in the REFERENCES clause. +** Consider this example: +** +** CREATE TABLE ex1( +** a INTEGER PRIMARY KEY, +** b INTEGER CONSTRAINT fk1 REFERENCES ex2(x) +** ); +** +** For foreign key "fk1", the from-table is "ex1" and the to-table is "ex2". +** +** Each REFERENCES clause generates an instance of the following structure +** which is attached to the from-table. The to-table need not exist when +** the from-table is created. The existance of the to-table is not checked +** until an attempt is made to insert data into the from-table. +** +** The sqlite.aFKey hash table stores pointers to this structure +** given the name of a to-table. For each to-table, all foreign keys +** associated with that table are on a linked list using the FKey.pNextTo +** field. +*/ +struct FKey { + Table *pFrom; /* The table that constains the REFERENCES clause */ + FKey *pNextFrom; /* Next foreign key in pFrom */ + char *zTo; /* Name of table that the key points to */ + FKey *pNextTo; /* Next foreign key that points to zTo */ + int nCol; /* Number of columns in this key */ + struct sColMap { /* Mapping of columns in pFrom to columns in zTo */ + int iFrom; /* Index of column in pFrom */ + char *zCol; /* Name of column in zTo. If 0 use PRIMARY KEY */ + } *aCol; /* One entry for each of nCol column s */ + u8 isDeferred; /* True if constraint checking is deferred till COMMIT */ + u8 updateConf; /* How to resolve conflicts that occur on UPDATE */ + u8 deleteConf; /* How to resolve conflicts that occur on DELETE */ + u8 insertConf; /* How to resolve conflicts that occur on INSERT */ +}; + +/* +** SQLite supports many different ways to resolve a constraint +** error. ROLLBACK processing means that a constraint violation +** causes the operation in process to fail and for the current transaction +** to be rolled back. ABORT processing means the operation in process +** fails and any prior changes from that one operation are backed out, +** but the transaction is not rolled back. FAIL processing means that +** the operation in progress stops and returns an error code. But prior +** changes due to the same operation are not backed out and no rollback +** occurs. IGNORE means that the particular row that caused the constraint +** error is not inserted or updated. Processing continues and no error +** is returned. REPLACE means that preexisting database rows that caused +** a UNIQUE constraint violation are removed so that the new insert or +** update can proceed. Processing continues and no error is reported. +** +** RESTRICT, SETNULL, and CASCADE actions apply only to foreign keys. +** RESTRICT is the same as ABORT for IMMEDIATE foreign keys and the +** same as ROLLBACK for DEFERRED keys. SETNULL means that the foreign +** key is set to NULL. CASCADE means that a DELETE or UPDATE of the +** referenced table row is propagated into the row that holds the +** foreign key. +** +** The following symbolic values are used to record which type +** of action to take. +*/ +#define OE_None 0 /* There is no constraint to check */ +#define OE_Rollback 1 /* Fail the operation and rollback the transaction */ +#define OE_Abort 2 /* Back out changes but do no rollback transaction */ +#define OE_Fail 3 /* Stop the operation but leave all prior changes */ +#define OE_Ignore 4 /* Ignore the error. Do not do the INSERT or UPDATE */ +#define OE_Replace 5 /* Delete existing record, then do INSERT or UPDATE */ + +#define OE_Restrict 6 /* OE_Abort for IMMEDIATE, OE_Rollback for DEFERRED */ +#define OE_SetNull 7 /* Set the foreign key value to NULL */ +#define OE_SetDflt 8 /* Set the foreign key value to its default */ +#define OE_Cascade 9 /* Cascade the changes */ + +#define OE_Default 99 /* Do whatever the default action is */ + + +/* +** An instance of the following structure is passed as the first +** argument to sqlite3VdbeKeyCompare and is used to control the +** comparison of the two index keys. +** +** If the KeyInfo.incrKey value is true and the comparison would +** otherwise be equal, then return a result as if the second key +** were larger. +*/ +struct KeyInfo { + sqlite3 *db; /* The database connection */ + u8 enc; /* Text encoding - one of the TEXT_Utf* values */ + u8 incrKey; /* Increase 2nd key by epsilon before comparison */ + u8 prefixIsEqual; /* Treat a prefix as equal */ + int nField; /* Number of entries in aColl[] */ + u8 *aSortOrder; /* If defined an aSortOrder[i] is true, sort DESC */ + CollSeq *aColl[1]; /* Collating sequence for each term of the key */ +}; + +/* +** Each SQL index is represented in memory by an +** instance of the following structure. +** +** The columns of the table that are to be indexed are described +** by the aiColumn[] field of this structure. For example, suppose +** we have the following table and index: +** +** CREATE TABLE Ex1(c1 int, c2 int, c3 text); +** CREATE INDEX Ex2 ON Ex1(c3,c1); +** +** In the Table structure describing Ex1, nCol==3 because there are +** three columns in the table. In the Index structure describing +** Ex2, nColumn==2 since 2 of the 3 columns of Ex1 are indexed. +** The value of aiColumn is {2, 0}. aiColumn[0]==2 because the +** first column to be indexed (c3) has an index of 2 in Ex1.aCol[]. +** The second column to be indexed (c1) has an index of 0 in +** Ex1.aCol[], hence Ex2.aiColumn[1]==0. +** +** The Index.onError field determines whether or not the indexed columns +** must be unique and what to do if they are not. When Index.onError=OE_None, +** it means this is not a unique index. Otherwise it is a unique index +** and the value of Index.onError indicate the which conflict resolution +** algorithm to employ whenever an attempt is made to insert a non-unique +** element. +*/ +struct Index { + char *zName; /* Name of this index */ + int nColumn; /* Number of columns in the table used by this index */ + int *aiColumn; /* Which columns are used by this index. 1st is 0 */ + unsigned *aiRowEst; /* Result of ANALYZE: Est. rows selected by each column */ + Table *pTable; /* The SQL table being indexed */ + int tnum; /* Page containing root of this index in database file */ + u8 onError; /* OE_Abort, OE_Ignore, OE_Replace, or OE_None */ + u8 autoIndex; /* True if is automatically created (ex: by UNIQUE) */ + char *zColAff; /* String defining the affinity of each column */ + Index *pNext; /* The next index associated with the same table */ + Schema *pSchema; /* Schema containing this index */ + u8 *aSortOrder; /* Array of size Index.nColumn. True==DESC, False==ASC */ + char **azColl; /* Array of collation sequence names for index */ +}; + +/* +** Each token coming out of the lexer is an instance of +** this structure. Tokens are also used as part of an expression. +** +** Note if Token.z==0 then Token.dyn and Token.n are undefined and +** may contain random values. Do not make any assuptions about Token.dyn +** and Token.n when Token.z==0. +*/ +struct Token { + const unsigned char *z; /* Text of the token. Not NULL-terminated! */ + unsigned dyn : 1; /* True for malloced memory, false for static */ + unsigned n : 31; /* Number of characters in this token */ +}; + +/* +** An instance of this structure contains information needed to generate +** code for a SELECT that contains aggregate functions. +** +** If Expr.op==TK_AGG_COLUMN or TK_AGG_FUNCTION then Expr.pAggInfo is a +** pointer to this structure. The Expr.iColumn field is the index in +** AggInfo.aCol[] or AggInfo.aFunc[] of information needed to generate +** code for that node. +** +** AggInfo.pGroupBy and AggInfo.aFunc.pExpr point to fields within the +** original Select structure that describes the SELECT statement. These +** fields do not need to be freed when deallocating the AggInfo structure. +*/ +struct AggInfo { + u8 directMode; /* Direct rendering mode means take data directly + ** from source tables rather than from accumulators */ + u8 useSortingIdx; /* In direct mode, reference the sorting index rather + ** than the source table */ + int sortingIdx; /* Cursor number of the sorting index */ + ExprList *pGroupBy; /* The group by clause */ + int nSortingColumn; /* Number of columns in the sorting index */ + struct AggInfo_col { /* For each column used in source tables */ + Table *pTab; /* Source table */ + int iTable; /* Cursor number of the source table */ + int iColumn; /* Column number within the source table */ + int iSorterColumn; /* Column number in the sorting index */ + int iMem; /* Memory location that acts as accumulator */ + Expr *pExpr; /* The original expression */ + } *aCol; + int nColumn; /* Number of used entries in aCol[] */ + int nColumnAlloc; /* Number of slots allocated for aCol[] */ + int nAccumulator; /* Number of columns that show through to the output. + ** Additional columns are used only as parameters to + ** aggregate functions */ + struct AggInfo_func { /* For each aggregate function */ + Expr *pExpr; /* Expression encoding the function */ + FuncDef *pFunc; /* The aggregate function implementation */ + int iMem; /* Memory location that acts as accumulator */ + int iDistinct; /* Ephermeral table used to enforce DISTINCT */ + } *aFunc; + int nFunc; /* Number of entries in aFunc[] */ + int nFuncAlloc; /* Number of slots allocated for aFunc[] */ +}; + +/* +** Each node of an expression in the parse tree is an instance +** of this structure. +** +** Expr.op is the opcode. The integer parser token codes are reused +** as opcodes here. For example, the parser defines TK_GE to be an integer +** code representing the ">=" operator. This same integer code is reused +** to represent the greater-than-or-equal-to operator in the expression +** tree. +** +** Expr.pRight and Expr.pLeft are subexpressions. Expr.pList is a list +** of argument if the expression is a function. +** +** Expr.token is the operator token for this node. For some expressions +** that have subexpressions, Expr.token can be the complete text that gave +** rise to the Expr. In the latter case, the token is marked as being +** a compound token. +** +** An expression of the form ID or ID.ID refers to a column in a table. +** For such expressions, Expr.op is set to TK_COLUMN and Expr.iTable is +** the integer cursor number of a VDBE cursor pointing to that table and +** Expr.iColumn is the column number for the specific column. If the +** expression is used as a result in an aggregate SELECT, then the +** value is also stored in the Expr.iAgg column in the aggregate so that +** it can be accessed after all aggregates are computed. +** +** If the expression is a function, the Expr.iTable is an integer code +** representing which function. If the expression is an unbound variable +** marker (a question mark character '?' in the original SQL) then the +** Expr.iTable holds the index number for that variable. +** +** If the expression is a subquery then Expr.iColumn holds an integer +** register number containing the result of the subquery. If the +** subquery gives a constant result, then iTable is -1. If the subquery +** gives a different answer at different times during statement processing +** then iTable is the address of a subroutine that computes the subquery. +** +** The Expr.pSelect field points to a SELECT statement. The SELECT might +** be the right operand of an IN operator. Or, if a scalar SELECT appears +** in an expression the opcode is TK_SELECT and Expr.pSelect is the only +** operand. +** +** If the Expr is of type OP_Column, and the table it is selecting from +** is a disk table or the "old.*" pseudo-table, then pTab points to the +** corresponding table definition. +*/ +struct Expr { + u8 op; /* Operation performed by this node */ + char affinity; /* The affinity of the column or 0 if not a column */ + u16 flags; /* Various flags. See below */ + CollSeq *pColl; /* The collation type of the column or 0 */ + Expr *pLeft, *pRight; /* Left and right subnodes */ + ExprList *pList; /* A list of expressions used as function arguments + ** or in " IN (aCol[] or ->aFunc[] */ + int iRightJoinTable; /* If EP_FromJoin, the right table of the join */ + Select *pSelect; /* When the expression is a sub-select. Also the + ** right side of " IN (